Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 48854ae | 2010-10-17 12:52:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1 | libpng-manual.txt - A description on how to use and modify libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 72855fb | 2014-04-13 21:27:25 -0500 | [diff] [blame^] | 3 | libpng version 1.6.11beta04 - April 13, 2014 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4 | Updated and distributed by Glenn Randers-Pehrson |
| 5 | <glennrp at users.sourceforge.net> |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 6 | Copyright (c) 1998-2014 Glenn Randers-Pehrson |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 037023b | 2009-06-24 10:27:36 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 7 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | bfbf865 | 2009-06-26 21:46:52 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 8 | This document is released under the libpng license. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c332bbc | 2009-06-25 13:43:50 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 9 | For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 037023b | 2009-06-24 10:27:36 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 10 | and license in png.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 11 | |
| 12 | Based on: |
| 13 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 72855fb | 2014-04-13 21:27:25 -0500 | [diff] [blame^] | 14 | libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.6.11beta04 - April 13, 2014 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 15 | Updated and distributed by Glenn Randers-Pehrson |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 16 | Copyright (c) 1998-2014 Glenn Randers-Pehrson |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 17 | |
| 18 | libpng 1.0 beta 6 version 0.96 May 28, 1997 |
| 19 | Updated and distributed by Andreas Dilger |
| 20 | Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 Andreas Dilger |
| 21 | |
| 22 | libpng 1.0 beta 2 - version 0.88 January 26, 1996 |
| 23 | For conditions of distribution and use, see copyright |
| 24 | notice in png.h. Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Guy Eric |
| 25 | Schalnat, Group 42, Inc. |
| 26 | |
| 27 | Updated/rewritten per request in the libpng FAQ |
| 28 | Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Frank J. T. Wojcik |
| 29 | December 18, 1995 & January 20, 1996 |
| 30 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6e41842 | 2011-12-29 20:57:39 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 31 | TABLE OF CONTENTS |
| 32 | |
| 33 | I. Introduction |
| 34 | II. Structures |
| 35 | III. Reading |
| 36 | IV. Writing |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 37 | V. Simplified API |
| 38 | VI. Modifying/Customizing libpng |
| 39 | VII. MNG support |
| 40 | VIII. Changes to Libpng from version 0.88 |
| 41 | IX. Changes to Libpng from version 1.0.x to 1.2.x |
| 42 | X. Changes to Libpng from version 1.0.x/1.2.x to 1.4.x |
| 43 | XI. Changes to Libpng from version 1.4.x to 1.5.x |
| 44 | XII. Changes to Libpng from version 1.5.x to 1.6.x |
| 45 | XIII. Detecting libpng |
| 46 | XIV. Source code repository |
| 47 | XV. Coding style |
| 48 | XVI. Y2K Compliance in libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6e41842 | 2011-12-29 20:57:39 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 49 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 50 | I. Introduction |
| 51 | |
| 52 | This file describes how to use and modify the PNG reference library |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 53 | (known as libpng) for your own use. In addition to this |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 54 | file, example.c is a good starting point for using the library, as |
| 55 | it is heavily commented and should include everything most people |
| 56 | will need. We assume that libpng is already installed; see the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 57 | INSTALL file for instructions on how to configure and install libpng. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 58 | |
| 59 | For examples of libpng usage, see the files "example.c", "pngtest.c", |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 60 | and the files in the "contrib" directory, all of which are included in |
| 61 | the libpng distribution. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 62 | |
| 63 | Libpng was written as a companion to the PNG specification, as a way |
| 64 | of reducing the amount of time and effort it takes to support the PNG |
| 65 | file format in application programs. |
| 66 | |
| 67 | The PNG specification (second edition), November 2003, is available as |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 68 | a W3C Recommendation and as an ISO Standard (ISO/IEC 15948:2004 (E)) at |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 69 | <http://www.w3.org/TR/2003/REC-PNG-20031110/ |
| 70 | The W3C and ISO documents have identical technical content. |
| 71 | |
| 72 | The PNG-1.2 specification is available at |
| 73 | <http://www.libpng.org/pub/png/documents/>. It is technically equivalent |
| 74 | to the PNG specification (second edition) but has some additional material. |
| 75 | |
| 76 | The PNG-1.0 specification is available |
| 77 | as RFC 2083 <http://www.libpng.org/pub/png/documents/> and as a |
| 78 | W3C Recommendation <http://www.w3.org/TR/REC.png.html>. |
| 79 | |
| 80 | Some additional chunks are described in the special-purpose public chunks |
| 81 | documents at <http://www.libpng.org/pub/png/documents/>. |
| 82 | |
| 83 | Other information |
| 84 | about PNG, and the latest version of libpng, can be found at the PNG home |
| 85 | page, <http://www.libpng.org/pub/png/>. |
| 86 | |
| 87 | Most users will not have to modify the library significantly; advanced |
| 88 | users may want to modify it more. All attempts were made to make it as |
| 89 | complete as possible, while keeping the code easy to understand. |
| 90 | Currently, this library only supports C. Support for other languages |
| 91 | is being considered. |
| 92 | |
| 93 | Libpng has been designed to handle multiple sessions at one time, |
| 94 | to be easily modifiable, to be portable to the vast majority of |
| 95 | machines (ANSI, K&R, 16-, 32-, and 64-bit) available, and to be easy |
| 96 | to use. The ultimate goal of libpng is to promote the acceptance of |
| 97 | the PNG file format in whatever way possible. While there is still |
| 98 | work to be done (see the TODO file), libpng should cover the |
| 99 | majority of the needs of its users. |
| 100 | |
| 101 | Libpng uses zlib for its compression and decompression of PNG files. |
| 102 | Further information about zlib, and the latest version of zlib, can |
| 103 | be found at the zlib home page, <http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/zlib/>. |
| 104 | The zlib compression utility is a general purpose utility that is |
| 105 | useful for more than PNG files, and can be used without libpng. |
| 106 | See the documentation delivered with zlib for more details. |
| 107 | You can usually find the source files for the zlib utility wherever you |
| 108 | find the libpng source files. |
| 109 | |
| 110 | Libpng is thread safe, provided the threads are using different |
| 111 | instances of the structures. Each thread should have its own |
| 112 | png_struct and png_info instances, and thus its own image. |
| 113 | Libpng does not protect itself against two threads using the |
| 114 | same instance of a structure. |
| 115 | |
| 116 | II. Structures |
| 117 | |
| 118 | There are two main structures that are important to libpng, png_struct |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 119 | and png_info. Both are internal structures that are no longer exposed |
| 120 | in the libpng interface (as of libpng 1.5.0). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 121 | |
| 122 | The png_info structure is designed to provide information about the |
| 123 | PNG file. At one time, the fields of png_info were intended to be |
| 124 | directly accessible to the user. However, this tended to cause problems |
| 125 | with applications using dynamically loaded libraries, and as a result |
| 126 | a set of interface functions for png_info (the png_get_*() and png_set_*() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 127 | functions) was developed, and direct access to the png_info fields was |
| 128 | deprecated.. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 129 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 130 | The png_struct structure is the object used by the library to decode a |
| 131 | single image. As of 1.5.0 this structure is also not exposed. |
| 132 | |
| 133 | Almost all libpng APIs require a pointer to a png_struct as the first argument. |
| 134 | Many (in particular the png_set and png_get APIs) also require a pointer |
| 135 | to png_info as the second argument. Some application visible macros |
| 136 | defined in png.h designed for basic data access (reading and writing |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 137 | integers in the PNG format) don't take a png_info pointer, but it's almost |
| 138 | always safe to assume that a (png_struct*) has to be passed to call an API |
| 139 | function. |
| 140 | |
| 141 | You can have more than one png_info structure associated with an image, |
| 142 | as illustrated in pngtest.c, one for information valid prior to the |
| 143 | IDAT chunks and another (called "end_info" below) for things after them. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 144 | |
| 145 | The png.h header file is an invaluable reference for programming with libpng. |
| 146 | And while I'm on the topic, make sure you include the libpng header file: |
| 147 | |
| 148 | #include <png.h> |
| 149 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 150 | and also (as of libpng-1.5.0) the zlib header file, if you need it: |
| 151 | |
| 152 | #include <zlib.h> |
| 153 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 154 | Types |
| 155 | |
| 156 | The png.h header file defines a number of integral types used by the |
| 157 | APIs. Most of these are fairly obvious; for example types corresponding |
| 158 | to integers of particular sizes and types for passing color values. |
| 159 | |
| 160 | One exception is how non-integral numbers are handled. For application |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 161 | convenience most APIs that take such numbers have C (double) arguments; |
| 162 | however, internally PNG, and libpng, use 32 bit signed integers and encode |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 163 | the value by multiplying by 100,000. As of libpng 1.5.0 a convenience |
| 164 | macro PNG_FP_1 is defined in png.h along with a type (png_fixed_point) |
| 165 | which is simply (png_int_32). |
| 166 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 167 | All APIs that take (double) arguments also have a matching API that |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 168 | takes the corresponding fixed point integer arguments. The fixed point |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 169 | API has the same name as the floating point one with "_fixed" appended. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 170 | The actual range of values permitted in the APIs is frequently less than |
| 171 | the full range of (png_fixed_point) (-21474 to +21474). When APIs require |
| 172 | a non-negative argument the type is recorded as png_uint_32 above. Consult |
| 173 | the header file and the text below for more information. |
| 174 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 175 | Special care must be take with sCAL chunk handling because the chunk itself |
| 176 | uses non-integral values encoded as strings containing decimal floating point |
| 177 | numbers. See the comments in the header file. |
| 178 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 179 | Configuration |
| 180 | |
| 181 | The main header file function declarations are frequently protected by C |
| 182 | preprocessing directives of the form: |
| 183 | |
| 184 | #ifdef PNG_feature_SUPPORTED |
| 185 | declare-function |
| 186 | #endif |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 187 | ... |
| 188 | #ifdef PNG_feature_SUPPORTED |
| 189 | use-function |
| 190 | #endif |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 191 | |
| 192 | The library can be built without support for these APIs, although a |
| 193 | standard build will have all implemented APIs. Application programs |
| 194 | should check the feature macros before using an API for maximum |
| 195 | portability. From libpng 1.5.0 the feature macros set during the build |
| 196 | of libpng are recorded in the header file "pnglibconf.h" and this file |
| 197 | is always included by png.h. |
| 198 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 199 | If you don't need to change the library configuration from the default, skip to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 200 | the next section ("Reading"). |
| 201 | |
| 202 | Notice that some of the makefiles in the 'scripts' directory and (in 1.5.0) all |
| 203 | of the build project files in the 'projects' directory simply copy |
| 204 | scripts/pnglibconf.h.prebuilt to pnglibconf.h. This means that these build |
| 205 | systems do not permit easy auto-configuration of the library - they only |
| 206 | support the default configuration. |
| 207 | |
| 208 | The easiest way to make minor changes to the libpng configuration when |
| 209 | auto-configuration is supported is to add definitions to the command line |
| 210 | using (typically) CPPFLAGS. For example: |
| 211 | |
| 212 | CPPFLAGS=-DPNG_NO_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC |
| 213 | |
| 214 | will change the internal libpng math implementation for gamma correction and |
| 215 | other arithmetic calculations to fixed point, avoiding the need for fast |
| 216 | floating point support. The result can be seen in the generated pnglibconf.h - |
| 217 | make sure it contains the changed feature macro setting. |
| 218 | |
| 219 | If you need to make more extensive configuration changes - more than one or two |
| 220 | feature macro settings - you can either add -DPNG_USER_CONFIG to the build |
| 221 | command line and put a list of feature macro settings in pngusr.h or you can set |
| 222 | DFA_XTRA (a makefile variable) to a file containing the same information in the |
| 223 | form of 'option' settings. |
| 224 | |
| 225 | A. Changing pnglibconf.h |
| 226 | |
| 227 | A variety of methods exist to build libpng. Not all of these support |
| 228 | reconfiguration of pnglibconf.h. To reconfigure pnglibconf.h it must either be |
| 229 | rebuilt from scripts/pnglibconf.dfa using awk or it must be edited by hand. |
| 230 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 231 | Hand editing is achieved by copying scripts/pnglibconf.h.prebuilt to |
| 232 | pnglibconf.h and changing the lines defining the supported features, paying |
| 233 | very close attention to the 'option' information in scripts/pnglibconf.dfa |
| 234 | that describes those features and their requirements. This is easy to get |
| 235 | wrong. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 236 | |
| 237 | B. Configuration using DFA_XTRA |
| 238 | |
| 239 | Rebuilding from pnglibconf.dfa is easy if a functioning 'awk', or a later |
| 240 | variant such as 'nawk' or 'gawk', is available. The configure build will |
| 241 | automatically find an appropriate awk and build pnglibconf.h. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 242 | The scripts/pnglibconf.mak file contains a set of make rules for doing the |
| 243 | same thing if configure is not used, and many of the makefiles in the scripts |
| 244 | directory use this approach. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 245 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 246 | When rebuilding simply write a new file containing changed options and set |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 247 | DFA_XTRA to the name of this file. This causes the build to append the new file |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 248 | to the end of scripts/pnglibconf.dfa. The pngusr.dfa file should contain lines |
| 249 | of the following forms: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 250 | |
| 251 | everything = off |
| 252 | |
| 253 | This turns all optional features off. Include it at the start of pngusr.dfa to |
| 254 | make it easier to build a minimal configuration. You will need to turn at least |
| 255 | some features on afterward to enable either reading or writing code, or both. |
| 256 | |
| 257 | option feature on |
| 258 | option feature off |
| 259 | |
| 260 | Enable or disable a single feature. This will automatically enable other |
| 261 | features required by a feature that is turned on or disable other features that |
| 262 | require a feature which is turned off. Conflicting settings will cause an error |
| 263 | message to be emitted by awk. |
| 264 | |
| 265 | setting feature default value |
| 266 | |
| 267 | Changes the default value of setting 'feature' to 'value'. There are a small |
| 268 | number of settings listed at the top of pnglibconf.h, they are documented in the |
| 269 | source code. Most of these values have performance implications for the library |
| 270 | but most of them have no visible effect on the API. Some can also be overridden |
| 271 | from the API. |
| 272 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 273 | This method of building a customized pnglibconf.h is illustrated in |
| 274 | contrib/pngminim/*. See the "$(PNGCONF):" target in the makefile and |
| 275 | pngusr.dfa in these directories. |
| 276 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 277 | C. Configuration using PNG_USER_CONFIG |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 278 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 279 | If -DPNG_USER_CONFIG is added to the CPPFLAGS when pnglibconf.h is built, |
| 280 | the file pngusr.h will automatically be included before the options in |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 281 | scripts/pnglibconf.dfa are processed. Your pngusr.h file should contain only |
| 282 | macro definitions turning features on or off or setting settings. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 283 | |
| 284 | Apart from the global setting "everything = off" all the options listed above |
| 285 | can be set using macros in pngusr.h: |
| 286 | |
| 287 | #define PNG_feature_SUPPORTED |
| 288 | |
| 289 | is equivalent to: |
| 290 | |
| 291 | option feature on |
| 292 | |
| 293 | #define PNG_NO_feature |
| 294 | |
| 295 | is equivalent to: |
| 296 | |
| 297 | option feature off |
| 298 | |
| 299 | #define PNG_feature value |
| 300 | |
| 301 | is equivalent to: |
| 302 | |
| 303 | setting feature default value |
| 304 | |
| 305 | Notice that in both cases, pngusr.dfa and pngusr.h, the contents of the |
| 306 | pngusr file you supply override the contents of scripts/pnglibconf.dfa |
| 307 | |
| 308 | If confusing or incomprehensible behavior results it is possible to |
| 309 | examine the intermediate file pnglibconf.dfn to find the full set of |
| 310 | dependency information for each setting and option. Simply locate the |
| 311 | feature in the file and read the C comments that precede it. |
| 312 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 313 | This method is also illustrated in the contrib/pngminim/* makefiles and |
| 314 | pngusr.h. |
| 315 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 316 | III. Reading |
| 317 | |
| 318 | We'll now walk you through the possible functions to call when reading |
| 319 | in a PNG file sequentially, briefly explaining the syntax and purpose |
| 320 | of each one. See example.c and png.h for more detail. While |
| 321 | progressive reading is covered in the next section, you will still |
| 322 | need some of the functions discussed in this section to read a PNG |
| 323 | file. |
| 324 | |
| 325 | Setup |
| 326 | |
| 327 | You will want to do the I/O initialization(*) before you get into libpng, |
| 328 | so if it doesn't work, you don't have much to undo. Of course, you |
| 329 | will also want to insure that you are, in fact, dealing with a PNG |
| 330 | file. Libpng provides a simple check to see if a file is a PNG file. |
| 331 | To use it, pass in the first 1 to 8 bytes of the file to the function |
| 332 | png_sig_cmp(), and it will return 0 (false) if the bytes match the |
| 333 | corresponding bytes of the PNG signature, or nonzero (true) otherwise. |
| 334 | Of course, the more bytes you pass in, the greater the accuracy of the |
| 335 | prediction. |
| 336 | |
| 337 | If you are intending to keep the file pointer open for use in libpng, |
| 338 | you must ensure you don't read more than 8 bytes from the beginning |
| 339 | of the file, and you also have to make a call to png_set_sig_bytes_read() |
| 340 | with the number of bytes you read from the beginning. Libpng will |
| 341 | then only check the bytes (if any) that your program didn't read. |
| 342 | |
| 343 | (*): If you are not using the standard I/O functions, you will need |
| 344 | to replace them with custom functions. See the discussion under |
| 345 | Customizing libpng. |
| 346 | |
| 347 | |
| 348 | FILE *fp = fopen(file_name, "rb"); |
| 349 | if (!fp) |
| 350 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 351 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 352 | } |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 353 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 354 | fread(header, 1, number, fp); |
| 355 | is_png = !png_sig_cmp(header, 0, number); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 356 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 357 | if (!is_png) |
| 358 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 359 | return (NOT_PNG); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 360 | } |
| 361 | |
| 362 | |
| 363 | Next, png_struct and png_info need to be allocated and initialized. In |
| 364 | order to ensure that the size of these structures is correct even with a |
| 365 | dynamically linked libpng, there are functions to initialize and |
| 366 | allocate the structures. We also pass the library version, optional |
| 367 | pointers to error handling functions, and a pointer to a data struct for |
| 368 | use by the error functions, if necessary (the pointer and functions can |
| 369 | be NULL if the default error handlers are to be used). See the section |
| 370 | on Changes to Libpng below regarding the old initialization functions. |
| 371 | The structure allocation functions quietly return NULL if they fail to |
| 372 | create the structure, so your application should check for that. |
| 373 | |
| 374 | png_structp png_ptr = png_create_read_struct |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 375 | (PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, (png_voidp)user_error_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 376 | user_error_fn, user_warning_fn); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 377 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 378 | if (!png_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 379 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 380 | |
| 381 | png_infop info_ptr = png_create_info_struct(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 382 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 383 | if (!info_ptr) |
| 384 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 385 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 386 | (png_infopp)NULL, (png_infopp)NULL); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 387 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 388 | } |
| 389 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 390 | If you want to use your own memory allocation routines, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 391 | use a libpng that was built with PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED defined, and use |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 392 | png_create_read_struct_2() instead of png_create_read_struct(): |
| 393 | |
| 394 | png_structp png_ptr = png_create_read_struct_2 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 395 | (PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, (png_voidp)user_error_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 396 | user_error_fn, user_warning_fn, (png_voidp) |
| 397 | user_mem_ptr, user_malloc_fn, user_free_fn); |
| 398 | |
| 399 | The error handling routines passed to png_create_read_struct() |
| 400 | and the memory alloc/free routines passed to png_create_struct_2() |
| 401 | are only necessary if you are not using the libpng supplied error |
| 402 | handling and memory alloc/free functions. |
| 403 | |
| 404 | When libpng encounters an error, it expects to longjmp back |
| 405 | to your routine. Therefore, you will need to call setjmp and pass |
| 406 | your png_jmpbuf(png_ptr). If you read the file from different |
John Bowler | e6dc85b | 2011-04-27 14:47:15 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 407 | routines, you will need to update the longjmp buffer every time you enter |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 408 | a new routine that will call a png_*() function. |
| 409 | |
| 410 | See your documentation of setjmp/longjmp for your compiler for more |
| 411 | information on setjmp/longjmp. See the discussion on libpng error |
| 412 | handling in the Customizing Libpng section below for more information |
| 413 | on the libpng error handling. If an error occurs, and libpng longjmp's |
| 414 | back to your setjmp, you will want to call png_destroy_read_struct() to |
| 415 | free any memory. |
| 416 | |
| 417 | if (setjmp(png_jmpbuf(png_ptr))) |
| 418 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 419 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 420 | &end_info); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 421 | fclose(fp); |
| 422 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 423 | } |
| 424 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 425 | Pass (png_infopp)NULL instead of &end_info if you didn't create |
| 426 | an end_info structure. |
| 427 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 428 | If you would rather avoid the complexity of setjmp/longjmp issues, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 429 | you can compile libpng with PNG_NO_SETJMP, in which case |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 430 | errors will result in a call to PNG_ABORT() which defaults to abort(). |
| 431 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 432 | You can #define PNG_ABORT() to a function that does something |
| 433 | more useful than abort(), as long as your function does not |
| 434 | return. |
| 435 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 436 | Now you need to set up the input code. The default for libpng is to |
| 437 | use the C function fread(). If you use this, you will need to pass a |
| 438 | valid FILE * in the function png_init_io(). Be sure that the file is |
| 439 | opened in binary mode. If you wish to handle reading data in another |
| 440 | way, you need not call the png_init_io() function, but you must then |
| 441 | implement the libpng I/O methods discussed in the Customizing Libpng |
| 442 | section below. |
| 443 | |
| 444 | png_init_io(png_ptr, fp); |
| 445 | |
| 446 | If you had previously opened the file and read any of the signature from |
| 447 | the beginning in order to see if this was a PNG file, you need to let |
| 448 | libpng know that there are some bytes missing from the start of the file. |
| 449 | |
| 450 | png_set_sig_bytes(png_ptr, number); |
| 451 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 452 | You can change the zlib compression buffer size to be used while |
| 453 | reading compressed data with |
| 454 | |
| 455 | png_set_compression_buffer_size(png_ptr, buffer_size); |
| 456 | |
| 457 | where the default size is 8192 bytes. Note that the buffer size |
| 458 | is changed immediately and the buffer is reallocated immediately, |
| 459 | instead of setting a flag to be acted upon later. |
| 460 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9dd1cdf | 2011-01-06 21:42:36 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 461 | If you want CRC errors to be handled in a different manner than |
| 462 | the default, use |
| 463 | |
| 464 | png_set_crc_action(png_ptr, crit_action, ancil_action); |
| 465 | |
| 466 | The values for png_set_crc_action() say how libpng is to handle CRC errors in |
| 467 | ancillary and critical chunks, and whether to use the data contained |
| 468 | therein. Note that it is impossible to "discard" data in a critical |
| 469 | chunk. |
| 470 | |
| 471 | Choices for (int) crit_action are |
| 472 | PNG_CRC_DEFAULT 0 error/quit |
| 473 | PNG_CRC_ERROR_QUIT 1 error/quit |
| 474 | PNG_CRC_WARN_USE 3 warn/use data |
| 475 | PNG_CRC_QUIET_USE 4 quiet/use data |
| 476 | PNG_CRC_NO_CHANGE 5 use the current value |
| 477 | |
| 478 | Choices for (int) ancil_action are |
| 479 | PNG_CRC_DEFAULT 0 error/quit |
| 480 | PNG_CRC_ERROR_QUIT 1 error/quit |
| 481 | PNG_CRC_WARN_DISCARD 2 warn/discard data |
| 482 | PNG_CRC_WARN_USE 3 warn/use data |
| 483 | PNG_CRC_QUIET_USE 4 quiet/use data |
| 484 | PNG_CRC_NO_CHANGE 5 use the current value |
| 485 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 486 | Setting up callback code |
| 487 | |
| 488 | You can set up a callback function to handle any unknown chunks in the |
| 489 | input stream. You must supply the function |
| 490 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 81ce889 | 2011-01-24 08:04:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 491 | read_chunk_callback(png_structp png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 492 | png_unknown_chunkp chunk); |
| 493 | { |
| 494 | /* The unknown chunk structure contains your |
| 495 | chunk data, along with similar data for any other |
| 496 | unknown chunks: */ |
| 497 | |
| 498 | png_byte name[5]; |
| 499 | png_byte *data; |
| 500 | png_size_t size; |
| 501 | |
| 502 | /* Note that libpng has already taken care of |
| 503 | the CRC handling */ |
| 504 | |
| 505 | /* put your code here. Search for your chunk in the |
| 506 | unknown chunk structure, process it, and return one |
| 507 | of the following: */ |
| 508 | |
| 509 | return (-n); /* chunk had an error */ |
| 510 | return (0); /* did not recognize */ |
| 511 | return (n); /* success */ |
| 512 | } |
| 513 | |
| 514 | (You can give your function another name that you like instead of |
| 515 | "read_chunk_callback") |
| 516 | |
| 517 | To inform libpng about your function, use |
| 518 | |
| 519 | png_set_read_user_chunk_fn(png_ptr, user_chunk_ptr, |
| 520 | read_chunk_callback); |
| 521 | |
| 522 | This names not only the callback function, but also a user pointer that |
| 523 | you can retrieve with |
| 524 | |
| 525 | png_get_user_chunk_ptr(png_ptr); |
| 526 | |
| 527 | If you call the png_set_read_user_chunk_fn() function, then all unknown |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 528 | chunks which the callback does not handle will be saved when read. You can |
| 529 | cause them to be discarded by returning '1' ("handled") instead of '0'. This |
| 530 | behavior will change in libpng 1.7 and the default handling set by the |
| 531 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks() function, described below, will be used when the |
| 532 | callback returns 0. If you want the existing behavior you should set the global |
| 533 | default to PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_IF_SAFE now; this is compatible with all current |
| 534 | versions of libpng and with 1.7. Libpng 1.6 issues a warning if you keep the |
| 535 | default, or PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_NEVER, and the callback returns 0. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 536 | |
| 537 | At this point, you can set up a callback function that will be |
| 538 | called after each row has been read, which you can use to control |
| 539 | a progress meter or the like. It's demonstrated in pngtest.c. |
| 540 | You must supply a function |
| 541 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 81ce889 | 2011-01-24 08:04:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 542 | void read_row_callback(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 543 | png_uint_32 row, int pass); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 544 | { |
| 545 | /* put your code here */ |
| 546 | } |
| 547 | |
| 548 | (You can give it another name that you like instead of "read_row_callback") |
| 549 | |
| 550 | To inform libpng about your function, use |
| 551 | |
| 552 | png_set_read_status_fn(png_ptr, read_row_callback); |
| 553 | |
John Bowler | 59010e5 | 2011-02-16 06:16:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 554 | When this function is called the row has already been completely processed and |
| 555 | the 'row' and 'pass' refer to the next row to be handled. For the |
| 556 | non-interlaced case the row that was just handled is simply one less than the |
| 557 | passed in row number, and pass will always be 0. For the interlaced case the |
| 558 | same applies unless the row value is 0, in which case the row just handled was |
| 559 | the last one from one of the preceding passes. Because interlacing may skip a |
| 560 | pass you cannot be sure that the preceding pass is just 'pass-1', if you really |
| 561 | need to know what the last pass is record (row,pass) from the callback and use |
| 562 | the last recorded value each time. |
| 563 | |
| 564 | As with the user transform you can find the output row using the |
| 565 | PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW macro. |
| 566 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 567 | Unknown-chunk handling |
| 568 | |
| 569 | Now you get to set the way the library processes unknown chunks in the |
| 570 | input PNG stream. Both known and unknown chunks will be read. Normal |
| 571 | behavior is that known chunks will be parsed into information in |
| 572 | various info_ptr members while unknown chunks will be discarded. This |
| 573 | behavior can be wasteful if your application will never use some known |
| 574 | chunk types. To change this, you can call: |
| 575 | |
| 576 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(png_ptr, keep, |
| 577 | chunk_list, num_chunks); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 578 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 579 | keep - 0: default unknown chunk handling |
| 580 | 1: ignore; do not keep |
| 581 | 2: keep only if safe-to-copy |
| 582 | 3: keep even if unsafe-to-copy |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 583 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 584 | You can use these definitions: |
| 585 | PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_AS_DEFAULT 0 |
| 586 | PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_NEVER 1 |
| 587 | PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_IF_SAFE 2 |
| 588 | PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_ALWAYS 3 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 589 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 590 | chunk_list - list of chunks affected (a byte string, |
| 591 | five bytes per chunk, NULL or '\0' if |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 592 | num_chunks is positive; ignored if |
| 593 | numchunks <= 0). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 594 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 595 | num_chunks - number of chunks affected; if 0, all |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 596 | unknown chunks are affected. If positive, |
| 597 | only the chunks in the list are affected, |
| 598 | and if negative all unknown chunks and |
| 599 | all known chunks except for the IHDR, |
| 600 | PLTE, tRNS, IDAT, and IEND chunks are |
| 601 | affected. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 602 | |
| 603 | Unknown chunks declared in this way will be saved as raw data onto a |
| 604 | list of png_unknown_chunk structures. If a chunk that is normally |
| 605 | known to libpng is named in the list, it will be handled as unknown, |
| 606 | according to the "keep" directive. If a chunk is named in successive |
| 607 | instances of png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(), the final instance will |
| 608 | take precedence. The IHDR and IEND chunks should not be named in |
| 609 | chunk_list; if they are, libpng will process them normally anyway. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 610 | If you know that your application will never make use of some particular |
| 611 | chunks, use PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_NEVER (or 1) as demonstrated below. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 612 | |
| 613 | Here is an example of the usage of png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(), |
| 614 | where the private "vpAg" chunk will later be processed by a user chunk |
| 615 | callback function: |
| 616 | |
| 617 | png_byte vpAg[5]={118, 112, 65, 103, (png_byte) '\0'}; |
| 618 | |
| 619 | #if defined(PNG_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED) |
| 620 | png_byte unused_chunks[]= |
| 621 | { |
| 622 | 104, 73, 83, 84, (png_byte) '\0', /* hIST */ |
| 623 | 105, 84, 88, 116, (png_byte) '\0', /* iTXt */ |
| 624 | 112, 67, 65, 76, (png_byte) '\0', /* pCAL */ |
| 625 | 115, 67, 65, 76, (png_byte) '\0', /* sCAL */ |
| 626 | 115, 80, 76, 84, (png_byte) '\0', /* sPLT */ |
| 627 | 116, 73, 77, 69, (png_byte) '\0', /* tIME */ |
| 628 | }; |
| 629 | #endif |
| 630 | |
| 631 | ... |
| 632 | |
| 633 | #if defined(PNG_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 634 | /* ignore all unknown chunks |
| 635 | * (use global setting "2" for libpng16 and earlier): |
| 636 | */ |
| 637 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(read_ptr, 2, NULL, 0); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 638 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 639 | /* except for vpAg: */ |
| 640 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(read_ptr, 2, vpAg, 1); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 641 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 642 | /* also ignore unused known chunks: */ |
| 643 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(read_ptr, 1, unused_chunks, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 644 | (int)(sizeof unused_chunks)/5); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 645 | #endif |
| 646 | |
| 647 | User limits |
| 648 | |
| 649 | The PNG specification allows the width and height of an image to be as |
| 650 | large as 2^31-1 (0x7fffffff), or about 2.147 billion rows and columns. |
| 651 | Since very few applications really need to process such large images, |
| 652 | we have imposed an arbitrary 1-million limit on rows and columns. |
| 653 | Larger images will be rejected immediately with a png_error() call. If |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0cb906d | 2011-06-11 14:22:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 654 | you wish to change this limit, you can use |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 655 | |
| 656 | png_set_user_limits(png_ptr, width_max, height_max); |
| 657 | |
| 658 | to set your own limits, or use width_max = height_max = 0x7fffffffL |
| 659 | to allow all valid dimensions (libpng may reject some very large images |
| 660 | anyway because of potential buffer overflow conditions). |
| 661 | |
| 662 | You should put this statement after you create the PNG structure and |
| 663 | before calling png_read_info(), png_read_png(), or png_process_data(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cc27708 | 2011-06-10 21:17:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 664 | |
| 665 | When writing a PNG datastream, put this statement before calling |
| 666 | png_write_info() or png_write_png(). |
| 667 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 668 | If you need to retrieve the limits that are being applied, use |
| 669 | |
| 670 | width_max = png_get_user_width_max(png_ptr); |
| 671 | height_max = png_get_user_height_max(png_ptr); |
| 672 | |
| 673 | The PNG specification sets no limit on the number of ancillary chunks |
| 674 | allowed in a PNG datastream. You can impose a limit on the total number |
| 675 | of sPLT, tEXt, iTXt, zTXt, and unknown chunks that will be stored, with |
| 676 | |
| 677 | png_set_chunk_cache_max(png_ptr, user_chunk_cache_max); |
| 678 | |
| 679 | where 0x7fffffffL means unlimited. You can retrieve this limit with |
| 680 | |
| 681 | chunk_cache_max = png_get_chunk_cache_max(png_ptr); |
| 682 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 683 | You can also set a limit on the amount of memory that a compressed chunk |
| 684 | other than IDAT can occupy, with |
| 685 | |
| 686 | png_set_chunk_malloc_max(png_ptr, user_chunk_malloc_max); |
| 687 | |
| 688 | and you can retrieve the limit with |
| 689 | |
| 690 | chunk_malloc_max = png_get_chunk_malloc_max(png_ptr); |
| 691 | |
| 692 | Any chunks that would cause either of these limits to be exceeded will |
| 693 | be ignored. |
| 694 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 695 | Information about your system |
| 696 | |
| 697 | If you intend to display the PNG or to incorporate it in other image data you |
| 698 | need to tell libpng information about your display or drawing surface so that |
| 699 | libpng can convert the values in the image to match the display. |
| 700 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 701 | From libpng-1.5.4 this information can be set before reading the PNG file |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 702 | header. In earlier versions png_set_gamma() existed but behaved incorrectly if |
| 703 | called before the PNG file header had been read and png_set_alpha_mode() did not |
| 704 | exist. |
| 705 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 706 | If you need to support versions prior to libpng-1.5.4 test the version number |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 707 | as illustrated below using "PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504" and follow the procedures |
| 708 | described in the appropriate manual page. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 709 | |
| 710 | You give libpng the encoding expected by your system expressed as a 'gamma' |
| 711 | value. You can also specify a default encoding for the PNG file in |
| 712 | case the required information is missing from the file. By default libpng |
| 713 | assumes that the PNG data matches your system, to keep this default call: |
| 714 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 715 | png_set_gamma(png_ptr, screen_gamma, output_gamma); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 716 | |
| 717 | or you can use the fixed point equivalent: |
| 718 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 719 | png_set_gamma_fixed(png_ptr, PNG_FP_1*screen_gamma, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 720 | PNG_FP_1*output_gamma); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 721 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 722 | If you don't know the gamma for your system it is probably 2.2 - a good |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 723 | approximation to the IEC standard for display systems (sRGB). If images are |
| 724 | too contrasty or washed out you got the value wrong - check your system |
| 725 | documentation! |
| 726 | |
| 727 | Many systems permit the system gamma to be changed via a lookup table in the |
| 728 | display driver, a few systems, including older Macs, change the response by |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 729 | default. As of 1.5.4 three special values are available to handle common |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 730 | situations: |
| 731 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 732 | PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB: Indicates that the system conforms to the |
| 733 | IEC 61966-2-1 standard. This matches almost |
| 734 | all systems. |
| 735 | PNG_GAMMA_MAC_18: Indicates that the system is an older |
| 736 | (pre Mac OS 10.6) Apple Macintosh system with |
| 737 | the default settings. |
| 738 | PNG_GAMMA_LINEAR: Just the fixed point value for 1.0 - indicates |
| 739 | that the system expects data with no gamma |
| 740 | encoding. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 741 | |
| 742 | You would use the linear (unencoded) value if you need to process the pixel |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 743 | values further because this avoids the need to decode and re-encode each |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 744 | component value whenever arithmetic is performed. A lot of graphics software |
| 745 | uses linear values for this reason, often with higher precision component values |
| 746 | to preserve overall accuracy. |
| 747 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 748 | |
| 749 | The output_gamma value expresses how to decode the output values, not how |
| 750 | they are encoded. The values used correspond to the normal numbers used to |
| 751 | describe the overall gamma of a computer display system; for example 2.2 for |
| 752 | an sRGB conformant system. The values are scaled by 100000 in the _fixed |
| 753 | version of the API (so 220000 for sRGB.) |
| 754 | |
| 755 | The inverse of the value is always used to provide a default for the PNG file |
| 756 | encoding if it has no gAMA chunk and if png_set_gamma() has not been called |
| 757 | to override the PNG gamma information. |
| 758 | |
| 759 | When the ALPHA_OPTIMIZED mode is selected the output gamma is used to encode |
| 760 | opaque pixels however pixels with lower alpha values are not encoded, |
| 761 | regardless of the output gamma setting. |
| 762 | |
| 763 | When the standard Porter Duff handling is requested with mode 1 the output |
| 764 | encoding is set to be linear and the output_gamma value is only relevant |
| 765 | as a default for input data that has no gamma information. The linear output |
| 766 | encoding will be overridden if png_set_gamma() is called - the results may be |
| 767 | highly unexpected! |
| 768 | |
| 769 | The following numbers are derived from the sRGB standard and the research |
| 770 | behind it. sRGB is defined to be approximated by a PNG gAMA chunk value of |
| 771 | 0.45455 (1/2.2) for PNG. The value implicitly includes any viewing |
| 772 | correction required to take account of any differences in the color |
| 773 | environment of the original scene and the intended display environment; the |
| 774 | value expresses how to *decode* the image for display, not how the original |
| 775 | data was *encoded*. |
| 776 | |
| 777 | sRGB provides a peg for the PNG standard by defining a viewing environment. |
| 778 | sRGB itself, and earlier TV standards, actually use a more complex transform |
| 779 | (a linear portion then a gamma 2.4 power law) than PNG can express. (PNG is |
| 780 | limited to simple power laws.) By saying that an image for direct display on |
| 781 | an sRGB conformant system should be stored with a gAMA chunk value of 45455 |
| 782 | (11.3.3.2 and 11.3.3.5 of the ISO PNG specification) the PNG specification |
| 783 | makes it possible to derive values for other display systems and |
| 784 | environments. |
| 785 | |
| 786 | The Mac value is deduced from the sRGB based on an assumption that the actual |
| 787 | extra viewing correction used in early Mac display systems was implemented as |
| 788 | a power 1.45 lookup table. |
| 789 | |
| 790 | Any system where a programmable lookup table is used or where the behavior of |
| 791 | the final display device characteristics can be changed requires system |
| 792 | specific code to obtain the current characteristic. However this can be |
| 793 | difficult and most PNG gamma correction only requires an approximate value. |
| 794 | |
| 795 | By default, if png_set_alpha_mode() is not called, libpng assumes that all |
| 796 | values are unencoded, linear, values and that the output device also has a |
| 797 | linear characteristic. This is only very rarely correct - it is invariably |
| 798 | better to call png_set_alpha_mode() with PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB than rely on the |
| 799 | default if you don't know what the right answer is! |
| 800 | |
| 801 | The special value PNG_GAMMA_MAC_18 indicates an older Mac system (pre Mac OS |
| 802 | 10.6) which used a correction table to implement a somewhat lower gamma on an |
| 803 | otherwise sRGB system. |
| 804 | |
| 805 | Both these values are reserved (not simple gamma values) in order to allow |
| 806 | more precise correction internally in the future. |
| 807 | |
| 808 | NOTE: the values can be passed to either the fixed or floating |
| 809 | point APIs, but the floating point API will also accept floating point |
| 810 | values. |
| 811 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 812 | The second thing you may need to tell libpng about is how your system handles |
| 813 | alpha channel information. Some, but not all, PNG files contain an alpha |
| 814 | channel. To display these files correctly you need to compose the data onto a |
| 815 | suitable background, as described in the PNG specification. |
| 816 | |
| 817 | Libpng only supports composing onto a single color (using png_set_background; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 818 | see below). Otherwise you must do the composition yourself and, in this case, |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 819 | you may need to call png_set_alpha_mode: |
| 820 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 821 | #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504 |
| 822 | png_set_alpha_mode(png_ptr, mode, screen_gamma); |
| 823 | #else |
| 824 | png_set_gamma(png_ptr, screen_gamma, 1.0/screen_gamma); |
| 825 | #endif |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 826 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 827 | The screen_gamma value is the same as the argument to png_set_gamma; however, |
| 828 | how it affects the output depends on the mode. png_set_alpha_mode() sets the |
| 829 | file gamma default to 1/screen_gamma, so normally you don't need to call |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 830 | png_set_gamma. If you need different defaults call png_set_gamma() before |
| 831 | png_set_alpha_mode() - if you call it after it will override the settings made |
| 832 | by png_set_alpha_mode(). |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 833 | |
| 834 | The mode is as follows: |
| 835 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 836 | PNG_ALPHA_PNG: The data is encoded according to the PNG |
| 837 | specification. Red, green and blue, or gray, components are |
| 838 | gamma encoded color values and are not premultiplied by the |
| 839 | alpha value. The alpha value is a linear measure of the |
| 840 | contribution of the pixel to the corresponding final output pixel. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 841 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 842 | You should normally use this format if you intend to perform |
| 843 | color correction on the color values; most, maybe all, color |
| 844 | correction software has no handling for the alpha channel and, |
| 845 | anyway, the math to handle pre-multiplied component values is |
| 846 | unnecessarily complex. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 847 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 848 | Before you do any arithmetic on the component values you need |
| 849 | to remove the gamma encoding and multiply out the alpha |
| 850 | channel. See the PNG specification for more detail. It is |
| 851 | important to note that when an image with an alpha channel is |
| 852 | scaled, linear encoded, pre-multiplied component values must |
| 853 | be used! |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 854 | |
| 855 | The remaining modes assume you don't need to do any further color correction or |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 856 | that if you do, your color correction software knows all about alpha (it |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 857 | probably doesn't!). They 'associate' the alpha with the color information by |
| 858 | storing color channel values that have been scaled by the alpha. The |
| 859 | advantage is that the color channels can be resampled (the image can be |
| 860 | scaled) in this form. The disadvantage is that normal practice is to store |
| 861 | linear, not (gamma) encoded, values and this requires 16-bit channels for |
| 862 | still images rather than the 8-bit channels that are just about sufficient if |
| 863 | gamma encoding is used. In addition all non-transparent pixel values, |
| 864 | including completely opaque ones, must be gamma encoded to produce the final |
| 865 | image. These are the 'STANDARD', 'ASSOCIATED' or 'PREMULTIPLIED' modes |
| 866 | described below (the latter being the two common names for associated alpha |
| 867 | color channels). Note that PNG files always contain non-associated color |
| 868 | channels; png_set_alpha_mode() with one of the modes causes the decoder to |
| 869 | convert the pixels to an associated form before returning them to your |
| 870 | application. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 871 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 872 | Since it is not necessary to perform arithmetic on opaque color values so |
| 873 | long as they are not to be resampled and are in the final color space it is |
| 874 | possible to optimize the handling of alpha by storing the opaque pixels in |
| 875 | the PNG format (adjusted for the output color space) while storing partially |
| 876 | opaque pixels in the standard, linear, format. The accuracy required for |
| 877 | standard alpha composition is relatively low, because the pixels are |
| 878 | isolated, therefore typically the accuracy loss in storing 8-bit linear |
| 879 | values is acceptable. (This is not true if the alpha channel is used to |
| 880 | simulate transparency over large areas - use 16 bits or the PNG mode in |
| 881 | this case!) This is the 'OPTIMIZED' mode. For this mode a pixel is |
| 882 | treated as opaque only if the alpha value is equal to the maximum value. |
| 883 | |
| 884 | PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD: The data libpng produces is encoded in the |
| 885 | standard way assumed by most correctly written graphics software. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 886 | The gamma encoding will be removed by libpng and the |
| 887 | linear component values will be pre-multiplied by the |
| 888 | alpha channel. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 889 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 890 | With this format the final image must be re-encoded to |
| 891 | match the display gamma before the image is displayed. |
| 892 | If your system doesn't do that, yet still seems to |
| 893 | perform arithmetic on the pixels without decoding them, |
| 894 | it is broken - check out the modes below. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 895 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 896 | With PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD libpng always produces linear |
| 897 | component values, whatever screen_gamma you supply. The |
| 898 | screen_gamma value is, however, used as a default for |
| 899 | the file gamma if the PNG file has no gamma information. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 900 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 901 | If you call png_set_gamma() after png_set_alpha_mode() you |
| 902 | will override the linear encoding. Instead the |
| 903 | pre-multiplied pixel values will be gamma encoded but |
| 904 | the alpha channel will still be linear. This may |
| 905 | actually match the requirements of some broken software, |
| 906 | but it is unlikely. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 907 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 908 | While linear 8-bit data is often used it has |
| 909 | insufficient precision for any image with a reasonable |
| 910 | dynamic range. To avoid problems, and if your software |
| 911 | supports it, use png_set_expand_16() to force all |
| 912 | components to 16 bits. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 913 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 914 | PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED: This mode is the same as PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD |
| 915 | except that completely opaque pixels are gamma encoded according to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 916 | the screen_gamma value. Pixels with alpha less than 1.0 |
| 917 | will still have linear components. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 918 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 919 | Use this format if you have control over your |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 920 | compositing software and so don't do other arithmetic |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 921 | (such as scaling) on the data you get from libpng. Your |
| 922 | compositing software can simply copy opaque pixels to |
| 923 | the output but still has linear values for the |
| 924 | non-opaque pixels. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 925 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 926 | In normal compositing, where the alpha channel encodes |
| 927 | partial pixel coverage (as opposed to broad area |
| 928 | translucency), the inaccuracies of the 8-bit |
| 929 | representation of non-opaque pixels are irrelevant. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 930 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 931 | You can also try this format if your software is broken; |
| 932 | it might look better. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 933 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 934 | PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN: This is PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD; however, all component |
| 935 | values, including the alpha channel are gamma encoded. This is |
| 936 | broken because, in practice, no implementation that uses this choice |
| 937 | correctly undoes the encoding before handling alpha composition. Use this |
| 938 | choice only if other serious errors in the software or hardware you use |
| 939 | mandate it. In most cases of broken software or hardware the bug in the |
| 940 | final display manifests as a subtle halo around composited parts of the |
| 941 | image. You may not even perceive this as a halo; the composited part of |
| 942 | the image may simply appear separate from the background, as though it had |
| 943 | been cut out of paper and pasted on afterward. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 944 | |
| 945 | If you don't have to deal with bugs in software or hardware, or if you can fix |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 946 | them, there are three recommended ways of using png_set_alpha_mode(): |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 947 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 948 | png_set_alpha_mode(png_ptr, PNG_ALPHA_PNG, |
| 949 | screen_gamma); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 950 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 951 | You can do color correction on the result (libpng does not currently |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 952 | support color correction internally). When you handle the alpha channel |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 953 | you need to undo the gamma encoding and multiply out the alpha. |
| 954 | |
| 955 | png_set_alpha_mode(png_ptr, PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD, |
| 956 | screen_gamma); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 957 | png_set_expand_16(png_ptr); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 958 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 959 | If you are using the high level interface, don't call png_set_expand_16(); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 960 | instead pass PNG_TRANSFORM_EXPAND_16 to the interface. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 961 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 962 | With this mode you can't do color correction, but you can do arithmetic, |
| 963 | including composition and scaling, on the data without further processing. |
| 964 | |
| 965 | png_set_alpha_mode(png_ptr, PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED, |
| 966 | screen_gamma); |
| 967 | |
| 968 | You can avoid the expansion to 16-bit components with this mode, but you |
| 969 | lose the ability to scale the image or perform other linear arithmetic. |
| 970 | All you can do is compose the result onto a matching output. Since this |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 971 | mode is libpng-specific you also need to write your own composition |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 972 | software. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 973 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 974 | The following are examples of calls to png_set_alpha_mode to achieve the |
| 975 | required overall gamma correction and, where necessary, alpha |
| 976 | premultiplication. |
| 977 | |
| 978 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_PNG, PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB); |
| 979 | |
| 980 | This is the default libpng handling of the alpha channel - it is not |
| 981 | pre-multiplied into the color components. In addition the call states |
| 982 | that the output is for a sRGB system and causes all PNG files without gAMA |
| 983 | chunks to be assumed to be encoded using sRGB. |
| 984 | |
| 985 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_PNG, PNG_GAMMA_MAC); |
| 986 | |
| 987 | In this case the output is assumed to be something like an sRGB conformant |
| 988 | display preceeded by a power-law lookup table of power 1.45. This is how |
| 989 | early Mac systems behaved. |
| 990 | |
| 991 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD, PNG_GAMMA_LINEAR); |
| 992 | |
| 993 | This is the classic Jim Blinn approach and will work in academic |
| 994 | environments where everything is done by the book. It has the shortcoming |
| 995 | of assuming that input PNG data with no gamma information is linear - this |
| 996 | is unlikely to be correct unless the PNG files where generated locally. |
| 997 | Most of the time the output precision will be so low as to show |
| 998 | significant banding in dark areas of the image. |
| 999 | |
| 1000 | png_set_expand_16(pp); |
| 1001 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD, PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB); |
| 1002 | |
| 1003 | This is a somewhat more realistic Jim Blinn inspired approach. PNG files |
| 1004 | are assumed to have the sRGB encoding if not marked with a gamma value and |
| 1005 | the output is always 16 bits per component. This permits accurate scaling |
| 1006 | and processing of the data. If you know that your input PNG files were |
| 1007 | generated locally you might need to replace PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB with the |
| 1008 | correct value for your system. |
| 1009 | |
| 1010 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED, PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB); |
| 1011 | |
| 1012 | If you just need to composite the PNG image onto an existing background |
| 1013 | and if you control the code that does this you can use the optimization |
| 1014 | setting. In this case you just copy completely opaque pixels to the |
| 1015 | output. For pixels that are not completely transparent (you just skip |
| 1016 | those) you do the composition math using png_composite or png_composite_16 |
| 1017 | below then encode the resultant 8-bit or 16-bit values to match the output |
| 1018 | encoding. |
| 1019 | |
| 1020 | Other cases |
| 1021 | |
| 1022 | If neither the PNG nor the standard linear encoding work for you because |
| 1023 | of the software or hardware you use then you have a big problem. The PNG |
| 1024 | case will probably result in halos around the image. The linear encoding |
| 1025 | will probably result in a washed out, too bright, image (it's actually too |
| 1026 | contrasty.) Try the ALPHA_OPTIMIZED mode above - this will probably |
| 1027 | substantially reduce the halos. Alternatively try: |
| 1028 | |
| 1029 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN, PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB); |
| 1030 | |
| 1031 | This option will also reduce the halos, but there will be slight dark |
| 1032 | halos round the opaque parts of the image where the background is light. |
| 1033 | In the OPTIMIZED mode the halos will be light halos where the background |
| 1034 | is dark. Take your pick - the halos are unavoidable unless you can get |
| 1035 | your hardware/software fixed! (The OPTIMIZED approach is slightly |
| 1036 | faster.) |
| 1037 | |
| 1038 | When the default gamma of PNG files doesn't match the output gamma. |
| 1039 | If you have PNG files with no gamma information png_set_alpha_mode allows |
| 1040 | you to provide a default gamma, but it also sets the ouput gamma to the |
| 1041 | matching value. If you know your PNG files have a gamma that doesn't |
| 1042 | match the output you can take advantage of the fact that |
| 1043 | png_set_alpha_mode always sets the output gamma but only sets the PNG |
| 1044 | default if it is not already set: |
| 1045 | |
| 1046 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_PNG, PNG_DEFAULT_sRGB); |
| 1047 | png_set_alpha_mode(pp, PNG_ALPHA_PNG, PNG_GAMMA_MAC); |
| 1048 | |
| 1049 | The first call sets both the default and the output gamma values, the |
| 1050 | second call overrides the output gamma without changing the default. This |
| 1051 | is easier than achieving the same effect with png_set_gamma. You must use |
| 1052 | PNG_ALPHA_PNG for the first call - internal checking in png_set_alpha will |
| 1053 | fire if more than one call to png_set_alpha_mode and png_set_background is |
| 1054 | made in the same read operation, however multiple calls with PNG_ALPHA_PNG |
| 1055 | are ignored. |
| 1056 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1057 | If you don't need, or can't handle, the alpha channel you can call |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1058 | png_set_background() to remove it by compositing against a fixed color. Don't |
| 1059 | call png_set_strip_alpha() to do this - it will leave spurious pixel values in |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1060 | transparent parts of this image. |
| 1061 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1062 | png_set_background(png_ptr, &background_color, |
| 1063 | PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN, 0, 1); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1064 | |
| 1065 | The background_color is an RGB or grayscale value according to the data format |
| 1066 | libpng will produce for you. Because you don't yet know the format of the PNG |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1067 | file, if you call png_set_background at this point you must arrange for the |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1068 | format produced by libpng to always have 8-bit or 16-bit components and then |
| 1069 | store the color as an 8-bit or 16-bit color as appropriate. The color contains |
| 1070 | separate gray and RGB component values, so you can let libpng produce gray or |
| 1071 | RGB output according to the input format, but low bit depth grayscale images |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1072 | must always be converted to at least 8-bit format. (Even though low bit depth |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1073 | grayscale images can't have an alpha channel they can have a transparent |
| 1074 | color!) |
| 1075 | |
| 1076 | You set the transforms you need later, either as flags to the high level |
| 1077 | interface or libpng API calls for the low level interface. For reference the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1078 | settings and API calls required are: |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1079 | |
| 1080 | 8-bit values: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1081 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SCALE_16 | PNG_EXPAND |
| 1082 | png_set_expand(png_ptr); png_set_scale_16(png_ptr); |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1083 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1084 | If you must get exactly the same inaccurate results |
| 1085 | produced by default in versions prior to libpng-1.5.4, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1086 | use PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_16 and png_set_strip_16(png_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1087 | instead. |
| 1088 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1089 | 16-bit values: |
| 1090 | PNG_TRANSFORM_EXPAND_16 |
| 1091 | png_set_expand_16(png_ptr); |
| 1092 | |
| 1093 | In either case palette image data will be expanded to RGB. If you just want |
| 1094 | color data you can add PNG_TRANSFORM_GRAY_TO_RGB or png_set_gray_to_rgb(png_ptr) |
| 1095 | to the list. |
| 1096 | |
| 1097 | Calling png_set_background before the PNG file header is read will not work |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1098 | prior to libpng-1.5.4. Because the failure may result in unexpected warnings or |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1099 | errors it is therefore much safer to call png_set_background after the head has |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1100 | been read. Unfortunately this means that prior to libpng-1.5.4 it cannot be |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1101 | used with the high level interface. |
| 1102 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1103 | The high-level read interface |
| 1104 | |
| 1105 | At this point there are two ways to proceed; through the high-level |
| 1106 | read interface, or through a sequence of low-level read operations. |
| 1107 | You can use the high-level interface if (a) you are willing to read |
| 1108 | the entire image into memory, and (b) the input transformations |
| 1109 | you want to do are limited to the following set: |
| 1110 | |
| 1111 | PNG_TRANSFORM_IDENTITY No transformation |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1112 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SCALE_16 Strip 16-bit samples to |
| 1113 | 8-bit accurately |
| 1114 | PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_16 Chop 16-bit samples to |
| 1115 | 8-bit less accurately |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1116 | PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_ALPHA Discard the alpha channel |
| 1117 | PNG_TRANSFORM_PACKING Expand 1, 2 and 4-bit |
| 1118 | samples to bytes |
| 1119 | PNG_TRANSFORM_PACKSWAP Change order of packed |
| 1120 | pixels to LSB first |
| 1121 | PNG_TRANSFORM_EXPAND Perform set_expand() |
| 1122 | PNG_TRANSFORM_INVERT_MONO Invert monochrome images |
| 1123 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SHIFT Normalize pixels to the |
| 1124 | sBIT depth |
| 1125 | PNG_TRANSFORM_BGR Flip RGB to BGR, RGBA |
| 1126 | to BGRA |
| 1127 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SWAP_ALPHA Flip RGBA to ARGB or GA |
| 1128 | to AG |
| 1129 | PNG_TRANSFORM_INVERT_ALPHA Change alpha from opacity |
| 1130 | to transparency |
| 1131 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SWAP_ENDIAN Byte-swap 16-bit samples |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 99708d5 | 2009-06-29 17:30:00 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1132 | PNG_TRANSFORM_GRAY_TO_RGB Expand grayscale samples |
| 1133 | to RGB (or GA to RGBA) |
John Bowler | a9b3419 | 2011-05-08 19:46:51 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1134 | PNG_TRANSFORM_EXPAND_16 Expand samples to 16 bits |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1135 | |
| 1136 | (This excludes setting a background color, doing gamma transformation, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1137 | quantizing, and setting filler.) If this is the case, simply do this: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1138 | |
| 1139 | png_read_png(png_ptr, info_ptr, png_transforms, NULL) |
| 1140 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1141 | where png_transforms is an integer containing the bitwise OR of some |
| 1142 | set of transformation flags. This call is equivalent to png_read_info(), |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1143 | followed the set of transformations indicated by the transform mask, |
| 1144 | then png_read_image(), and finally png_read_end(). |
| 1145 | |
| 1146 | (The final parameter of this call is not yet used. Someday it might point |
| 1147 | to transformation parameters required by some future input transform.) |
| 1148 | |
| 1149 | You must use png_transforms and not call any png_set_transform() functions |
| 1150 | when you use png_read_png(). |
| 1151 | |
| 1152 | After you have called png_read_png(), you can retrieve the image data |
| 1153 | with |
| 1154 | |
| 1155 | row_pointers = png_get_rows(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 1156 | |
| 1157 | where row_pointers is an array of pointers to the pixel data for each row: |
| 1158 | |
| 1159 | png_bytep row_pointers[height]; |
| 1160 | |
| 1161 | If you know your image size and pixel size ahead of time, you can allocate |
| 1162 | row_pointers prior to calling png_read_png() with |
| 1163 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1164 | if (height > PNG_UINT_32_MAX/(sizeof (png_byte))) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1165 | png_error (png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1166 | "Image is too tall to process in memory"); |
| 1167 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1168 | if (width > PNG_UINT_32_MAX/pixel_size) |
| 1169 | png_error (png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1170 | "Image is too wide to process in memory"); |
| 1171 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1172 | row_pointers = png_malloc(png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1173 | height*(sizeof (png_bytep))); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1174 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1175 | for (int i=0; i<height, i++) |
| 1176 | row_pointers[i]=NULL; /* security precaution */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1177 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1178 | for (int i=0; i<height, i++) |
| 1179 | row_pointers[i]=png_malloc(png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1180 | width*pixel_size); |
| 1181 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1182 | png_set_rows(png_ptr, info_ptr, &row_pointers); |
| 1183 | |
| 1184 | Alternatively you could allocate your image in one big block and define |
| 1185 | row_pointers[i] to point into the proper places in your block. |
| 1186 | |
| 1187 | If you use png_set_rows(), the application is responsible for freeing |
| 1188 | row_pointers (and row_pointers[i], if they were separately allocated). |
| 1189 | |
| 1190 | If you don't allocate row_pointers ahead of time, png_read_png() will |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1191 | do it, and it'll be free'ed by libpng when you call png_destroy_*(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1192 | |
| 1193 | The low-level read interface |
| 1194 | |
| 1195 | If you are going the low-level route, you are now ready to read all |
| 1196 | the file information up to the actual image data. You do this with a |
| 1197 | call to png_read_info(). |
| 1198 | |
| 1199 | png_read_info(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 1200 | |
| 1201 | This will process all chunks up to but not including the image data. |
| 1202 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1203 | This also copies some of the data from the PNG file into the decode structure |
| 1204 | for use in later transformations. Important information copied in is: |
| 1205 | |
| 1206 | 1) The PNG file gamma from the gAMA chunk. This overwrites the default value |
| 1207 | provided by an earlier call to png_set_gamma or png_set_alpha_mode. |
| 1208 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1209 | 2) Prior to libpng-1.5.4 the background color from a bKGd chunk. This |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1210 | damages the information provided by an earlier call to png_set_background |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1211 | resulting in unexpected behavior. Libpng-1.5.4 no longer does this. |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1212 | |
| 1213 | 3) The number of significant bits in each component value. Libpng uses this to |
| 1214 | optimize gamma handling by reducing the internal lookup table sizes. |
| 1215 | |
| 1216 | 4) The transparent color information from a tRNS chunk. This can be modified by |
| 1217 | a later call to png_set_tRNS. |
| 1218 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1219 | Querying the info structure |
| 1220 | |
| 1221 | Functions are used to get the information from the info_ptr once it |
| 1222 | has been read. Note that these fields may not be completely filled |
| 1223 | in until png_read_end() has read the chunk data following the image. |
| 1224 | |
| 1225 | png_get_IHDR(png_ptr, info_ptr, &width, &height, |
| 1226 | &bit_depth, &color_type, &interlace_type, |
| 1227 | &compression_type, &filter_method); |
| 1228 | |
| 1229 | width - holds the width of the image |
| 1230 | in pixels (up to 2^31). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1231 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1232 | height - holds the height of the image |
| 1233 | in pixels (up to 2^31). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1234 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1235 | bit_depth - holds the bit depth of one of the |
| 1236 | image channels. (valid values are |
| 1237 | 1, 2, 4, 8, 16 and depend also on |
| 1238 | the color_type. See also |
| 1239 | significant bits (sBIT) below). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1240 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1241 | color_type - describes which color/alpha channels |
| 1242 | are present. |
| 1243 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY |
| 1244 | (bit depths 1, 2, 4, 8, 16) |
| 1245 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA |
| 1246 | (bit depths 8, 16) |
| 1247 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE |
| 1248 | (bit depths 1, 2, 4, 8) |
| 1249 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB |
| 1250 | (bit_depths 8, 16) |
| 1251 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA |
| 1252 | (bit_depths 8, 16) |
| 1253 | |
| 1254 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_PALETTE |
| 1255 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR |
| 1256 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA |
| 1257 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2cb633b | 2011-01-21 08:31:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1258 | interlace_type - (PNG_INTERLACE_NONE or |
| 1259 | PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7) |
| 1260 | |
| 1261 | compression_type - (must be PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE |
| 1262 | for PNG 1.0) |
| 1263 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1264 | filter_method - (must be PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE |
| 1265 | for PNG 1.0, and can also be |
| 1266 | PNG_INTRAPIXEL_DIFFERENCING if |
| 1267 | the PNG datastream is embedded in |
| 1268 | a MNG-1.0 datastream) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1269 | |
| 1270 | Any or all of interlace_type, compression_type, or |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1271 | filter_method can be NULL if you are |
| 1272 | not interested in their values. |
| 1273 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1274 | Note that png_get_IHDR() returns 32-bit data into |
| 1275 | the application's width and height variables. |
| 1276 | This is an unsafe situation if these are 16-bit |
| 1277 | variables. In such situations, the |
| 1278 | png_get_image_width() and png_get_image_height() |
| 1279 | functions described below are safer. |
| 1280 | |
| 1281 | width = png_get_image_width(png_ptr, |
| 1282 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1283 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1284 | height = png_get_image_height(png_ptr, |
| 1285 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1286 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1287 | bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(png_ptr, |
| 1288 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1289 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1290 | color_type = png_get_color_type(png_ptr, |
| 1291 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1292 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2cb633b | 2011-01-21 08:31:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1293 | interlace_type = png_get_interlace_type(png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1294 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1295 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1296 | compression_type = png_get_compression_type(png_ptr, |
| 1297 | info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1298 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2cb633b | 2011-01-21 08:31:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1299 | filter_method = png_get_filter_type(png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | b35a745 | 2009-09-30 23:12:13 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1300 | info_ptr); |
| 1301 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1302 | channels = png_get_channels(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1303 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1304 | channels - number of channels of info for the |
| 1305 | color type (valid values are 1 (GRAY, |
| 1306 | PALETTE), 2 (GRAY_ALPHA), 3 (RGB), |
| 1307 | 4 (RGB_ALPHA or RGB + filler byte)) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1308 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1309 | rowbytes = png_get_rowbytes(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1310 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1311 | rowbytes - number of bytes needed to hold a row |
| 1312 | |
| 1313 | signature = png_get_signature(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1314 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1315 | signature - holds the signature read from the |
| 1316 | file (if any). The data is kept in |
| 1317 | the same offset it would be if the |
| 1318 | whole signature were read (i.e. if an |
| 1319 | application had already read in 4 |
| 1320 | bytes of signature before starting |
| 1321 | libpng, the remaining 4 bytes would |
| 1322 | be in signature[4] through signature[7] |
| 1323 | (see png_set_sig_bytes())). |
| 1324 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1325 | These are also important, but their validity depends on whether the chunk |
| 1326 | has been read. The png_get_valid(png_ptr, info_ptr, PNG_INFO_<chunk>) and |
| 1327 | png_get_<chunk>(png_ptr, info_ptr, ...) functions return non-zero if the |
| 1328 | data has been read, or zero if it is missing. The parameters to the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1329 | png_get_<chunk> are set directly if they are simple data types, or a |
| 1330 | pointer into the info_ptr is returned for any complex types. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1331 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1332 | The colorspace data from gAMA, cHRM, sRGB, iCCP, and sBIT chunks |
| 1333 | is simply returned to give the application information about how the |
| 1334 | image was encoded. Libpng itself only does transformations using the file |
| 1335 | gamma when combining semitransparent pixels with the background color, and, |
| 1336 | since libpng-1.6.0, when converting between 8-bit sRGB and 16-bit linear pixels |
| 1337 | within the simplified API. Libpng also uses the file gamma when converting |
| 1338 | RGB to gray, beginning with libpng-1.0.5, if the application calls |
| 1339 | png_set_rgb_to_gray()). |
| 1340 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1341 | png_get_PLTE(png_ptr, info_ptr, &palette, |
| 1342 | &num_palette); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1343 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1344 | palette - the palette for the file |
| 1345 | (array of png_color) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1346 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1347 | num_palette - number of entries in the palette |
| 1348 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1349 | png_get_gAMA(png_ptr, info_ptr, &file_gamma); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2774238 | 2011-01-27 09:37:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1350 | png_get_gAMA_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, &int_file_gamma); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1351 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1352 | file_gamma - the gamma at which the file is |
| 1353 | written (PNG_INFO_gAMA) |
| 1354 | |
| 1355 | int_file_gamma - 100,000 times the gamma at which the |
| 1356 | file is written |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1357 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1358 | png_get_cHRM(png_ptr, info_ptr, &white_x, &white_y, &red_x, |
| 1359 | &red_y, &green_x, &green_y, &blue_x, &blue_y) |
| 1360 | png_get_cHRM_XYZ(png_ptr, info_ptr, &red_X, &red_Y, &red_Z, |
| 1361 | &green_X, &green_Y, &green_Z, &blue_X, &blue_Y, |
| 1362 | &blue_Z) |
| 1363 | png_get_cHRM_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, &int_white_x, |
| 1364 | &int_white_y, &int_red_x, &int_red_y, |
| 1365 | &int_green_x, &int_green_y, &int_blue_x, |
| 1366 | &int_blue_y) |
John Bowler | bbd17bd | 2011-08-25 17:48:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1367 | png_get_cHRM_XYZ_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, &int_red_X, &int_red_Y, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1368 | &int_red_Z, &int_green_X, &int_green_Y, |
| 1369 | &int_green_Z, &int_blue_X, &int_blue_Y, |
| 1370 | &int_blue_Z) |
John Bowler | bbd17bd | 2011-08-25 17:48:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1371 | |
| 1372 | {white,red,green,blue}_{x,y} |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1373 | A color space encoding specified using the |
| 1374 | chromaticities of the end points and the |
| 1375 | white point. (PNG_INFO_cHRM) |
John Bowler | bbd17bd | 2011-08-25 17:48:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1376 | |
| 1377 | {red,green,blue}_{X,Y,Z} |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1378 | A color space encoding specified using the |
| 1379 | encoding end points - the CIE tristimulus |
| 1380 | specification of the intended color of the red, |
| 1381 | green and blue channels in the PNG RGB data. |
| 1382 | The white point is simply the sum of the three |
| 1383 | end points. (PNG_INFO_cHRM) |
John Bowler | bbd17bd | 2011-08-25 17:48:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1384 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1385 | png_get_sRGB(png_ptr, info_ptr, &srgb_intent); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1386 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1387 | srgb_intent - the rendering intent (PNG_INFO_sRGB) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1388 | The presence of the sRGB chunk |
| 1389 | means that the pixel data is in the |
| 1390 | sRGB color space. This chunk also |
| 1391 | implies specific values of gAMA and |
| 1392 | cHRM. |
| 1393 | |
| 1394 | png_get_iCCP(png_ptr, info_ptr, &name, |
| 1395 | &compression_type, &profile, &proflen); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1396 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1397 | name - The profile name. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1398 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1399 | compression_type - The compression type; always |
| 1400 | PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE for PNG 1.0. |
| 1401 | You may give NULL to this argument to |
| 1402 | ignore it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1403 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1404 | profile - International Color Consortium color |
| 1405 | profile data. May contain NULs. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1406 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1407 | proflen - length of profile data in bytes. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1408 | |
| 1409 | png_get_sBIT(png_ptr, info_ptr, &sig_bit); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1410 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1411 | sig_bit - the number of significant bits for |
| 1412 | (PNG_INFO_sBIT) each of the gray, |
| 1413 | red, green, and blue channels, |
| 1414 | whichever are appropriate for the |
| 1415 | given color type (png_color_16) |
| 1416 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 866b62a | 2009-08-08 16:33:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1417 | png_get_tRNS(png_ptr, info_ptr, &trans_alpha, |
| 1418 | &num_trans, &trans_color); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1419 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 866b62a | 2009-08-08 16:33:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1420 | trans_alpha - array of alpha (transparency) |
| 1421 | entries for palette (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1422 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f3c51e4 | 2011-01-15 10:25:25 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1423 | num_trans - number of transparent entries |
| 1424 | (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1425 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1426 | trans_color - graylevel or color sample values of |
| 1427 | the single transparent color for |
| 1428 | non-paletted images (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1429 | |
| 1430 | png_get_hIST(png_ptr, info_ptr, &hist); |
| 1431 | (PNG_INFO_hIST) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1432 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1433 | hist - histogram of palette (array of |
| 1434 | png_uint_16) |
| 1435 | |
| 1436 | png_get_tIME(png_ptr, info_ptr, &mod_time); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1437 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1438 | mod_time - time image was last modified |
| 1439 | (PNG_VALID_tIME) |
| 1440 | |
| 1441 | png_get_bKGD(png_ptr, info_ptr, &background); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1442 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1443 | background - background color (of type |
| 1444 | png_color_16p) (PNG_VALID_bKGD) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1445 | valid 16-bit red, green and blue |
| 1446 | values, regardless of color_type |
| 1447 | |
| 1448 | num_comments = png_get_text(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
| 1449 | &text_ptr, &num_text); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1450 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1451 | num_comments - number of comments |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1452 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1453 | text_ptr - array of png_text holding image |
| 1454 | comments |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1455 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1456 | text_ptr[i].compression - type of compression used |
| 1457 | on "text" PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE |
| 1458 | PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt |
| 1459 | PNG_ITXT_COMPRESSION_NONE |
| 1460 | PNG_ITXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1461 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1462 | text_ptr[i].key - keyword for comment. Must contain |
| 1463 | 1-79 characters. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1464 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1465 | text_ptr[i].text - text comments for current |
| 1466 | keyword. Can be empty. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1467 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1468 | text_ptr[i].text_length - length of text string, |
| 1469 | after decompression, 0 for iTXt |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1470 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1471 | text_ptr[i].itxt_length - length of itxt string, |
| 1472 | after decompression, 0 for tEXt/zTXt |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1473 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1474 | text_ptr[i].lang - language of comment (empty |
| 1475 | string for unknown). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1476 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1477 | text_ptr[i].lang_key - keyword in UTF-8 |
| 1478 | (empty string for unknown). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1479 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ef29a5e | 2009-10-31 19:37:05 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1480 | Note that the itxt_length, lang, and lang_key |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 680da02 | 2011-11-21 17:05:41 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1481 | members of the text_ptr structure only exist when the |
| 1482 | library is built with iTXt chunk support. Prior to |
| 1483 | libpng-1.4.0 the library was built by default without |
| 1484 | iTXt support. Also note that when iTXt is supported, |
| 1485 | they contain NULL pointers when the "compression" |
| 1486 | field contains PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE or |
| 1487 | PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ef29a5e | 2009-10-31 19:37:05 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1488 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1489 | num_text - number of comments (same as |
| 1490 | num_comments; you can put NULL here |
| 1491 | to avoid the duplication) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1492 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1493 | Note while png_set_text() will accept text, language, |
| 1494 | and translated keywords that can be NULL pointers, the |
| 1495 | structure returned by png_get_text will always contain |
| 1496 | regular zero-terminated C strings. They might be |
| 1497 | empty strings but they will never be NULL pointers. |
| 1498 | |
| 1499 | num_spalettes = png_get_sPLT(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
| 1500 | &palette_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1501 | |
| 1502 | num_spalettes - number of sPLT chunks read. |
| 1503 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1504 | palette_ptr - array of palette structures holding |
| 1505 | contents of one or more sPLT chunks |
| 1506 | read. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1507 | |
| 1508 | png_get_oFFs(png_ptr, info_ptr, &offset_x, &offset_y, |
| 1509 | &unit_type); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1510 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1511 | offset_x - positive offset from the left edge |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1512 | of the screen (can be negative) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1513 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1514 | offset_y - positive offset from the top edge |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1515 | of the screen (can be negative) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1516 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1517 | unit_type - PNG_OFFSET_PIXEL, PNG_OFFSET_MICROMETER |
| 1518 | |
| 1519 | png_get_pHYs(png_ptr, info_ptr, &res_x, &res_y, |
| 1520 | &unit_type); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1521 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1522 | res_x - pixels/unit physical resolution in |
| 1523 | x direction |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1524 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1525 | res_y - pixels/unit physical resolution in |
| 1526 | x direction |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1527 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1528 | unit_type - PNG_RESOLUTION_UNKNOWN, |
| 1529 | PNG_RESOLUTION_METER |
| 1530 | |
| 1531 | png_get_sCAL(png_ptr, info_ptr, &unit, &width, |
| 1532 | &height) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1533 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1534 | unit - physical scale units (an integer) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1535 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1536 | width - width of a pixel in physical scale units |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1537 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1538 | height - height of a pixel in physical scale units |
| 1539 | (width and height are doubles) |
| 1540 | |
| 1541 | png_get_sCAL_s(png_ptr, info_ptr, &unit, &width, |
| 1542 | &height) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1543 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1544 | unit - physical scale units (an integer) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1545 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1546 | width - width of a pixel in physical scale units |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1547 | (expressed as a string) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1548 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1549 | height - height of a pixel in physical scale units |
| 1550 | (width and height are strings like "2.54") |
| 1551 | |
| 1552 | num_unknown_chunks = png_get_unknown_chunks(png_ptr, |
| 1553 | info_ptr, &unknowns) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1554 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1555 | unknowns - array of png_unknown_chunk |
| 1556 | structures holding unknown chunks |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1557 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1558 | unknowns[i].name - name of unknown chunk |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1559 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1560 | unknowns[i].data - data of unknown chunk |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1561 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1562 | unknowns[i].size - size of unknown chunk's data |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1563 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1564 | unknowns[i].location - position of chunk in file |
| 1565 | |
| 1566 | The value of "i" corresponds to the order in which the |
| 1567 | chunks were read from the PNG file or inserted with the |
| 1568 | png_set_unknown_chunks() function. |
| 1569 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1570 | The value of "location" is a bitwise "or" of |
| 1571 | |
| 1572 | PNG_HAVE_IHDR (0x01) |
| 1573 | PNG_HAVE_PLTE (0x02) |
| 1574 | PNG_AFTER_IDAT (0x08) |
| 1575 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1576 | The data from the pHYs chunk can be retrieved in several convenient |
| 1577 | forms: |
| 1578 | |
| 1579 | res_x = png_get_x_pixels_per_meter(png_ptr, |
| 1580 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1581 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1582 | res_y = png_get_y_pixels_per_meter(png_ptr, |
| 1583 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1584 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1585 | res_x_and_y = png_get_pixels_per_meter(png_ptr, |
| 1586 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1587 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1588 | res_x = png_get_x_pixels_per_inch(png_ptr, |
| 1589 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1590 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1591 | res_y = png_get_y_pixels_per_inch(png_ptr, |
| 1592 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1593 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1594 | res_x_and_y = png_get_pixels_per_inch(png_ptr, |
| 1595 | info_ptr) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1596 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1597 | aspect_ratio = png_get_pixel_aspect_ratio(png_ptr, |
| 1598 | info_ptr) |
| 1599 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1600 | Each of these returns 0 [signifying "unknown"] if |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1601 | the data is not present or if res_x is 0; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1602 | res_x_and_y is 0 if res_x != res_y |
| 1603 | |
| 1604 | Note that because of the way the resolutions are |
| 1605 | stored internally, the inch conversions won't |
| 1606 | come out to exactly even number. For example, |
| 1607 | 72 dpi is stored as 0.28346 pixels/meter, and |
| 1608 | when this is retrieved it is 71.9988 dpi, so |
| 1609 | be sure to round the returned value appropriately |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36bb79 | 2011-02-12 09:49:07 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1610 | if you want to display a reasonable-looking result. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1611 | |
| 1612 | The data from the oFFs chunk can be retrieved in several convenient |
| 1613 | forms: |
| 1614 | |
| 1615 | x_offset = png_get_x_offset_microns(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1616 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1617 | y_offset = png_get_y_offset_microns(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1618 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1619 | x_offset = png_get_x_offset_inches(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1620 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1621 | y_offset = png_get_y_offset_inches(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 1622 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1623 | Each of these returns 0 [signifying "unknown" if both |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1624 | x and y are 0] if the data is not present or if the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1625 | chunk is present but the unit is the pixel. The |
| 1626 | remark about inexact inch conversions applies here |
| 1627 | as well, because a value in inches can't always be |
| 1628 | converted to microns and back without some loss |
| 1629 | of precision. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1630 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1631 | For more information, see the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1632 | PNG specification for chunk contents. Be careful with trusting |
| 1633 | rowbytes, as some of the transformations could increase the space |
| 1634 | needed to hold a row (expand, filler, gray_to_rgb, etc.). |
| 1635 | See png_read_update_info(), below. |
| 1636 | |
| 1637 | A quick word about text_ptr and num_text. PNG stores comments in |
| 1638 | keyword/text pairs, one pair per chunk, with no limit on the number |
| 1639 | of text chunks, and a 2^31 byte limit on their size. While there are |
| 1640 | suggested keywords, there is no requirement to restrict the use to these |
| 1641 | strings. It is strongly suggested that keywords and text be sensible |
| 1642 | to humans (that's the point), so don't use abbreviations. Non-printing |
| 1643 | symbols are not allowed. See the PNG specification for more details. |
| 1644 | There is also no requirement to have text after the keyword. |
| 1645 | |
| 1646 | Keywords should be limited to 79 Latin-1 characters without leading or |
| 1647 | trailing spaces, but non-consecutive spaces are allowed within the |
| 1648 | keyword. It is possible to have the same keyword any number of times. |
| 1649 | The text_ptr is an array of png_text structures, each holding a |
| 1650 | pointer to a language string, a pointer to a keyword and a pointer to |
| 1651 | a text string. The text string, language code, and translated |
| 1652 | keyword may be empty or NULL pointers. The keyword/text |
| 1653 | pairs are put into the array in the order that they are received. |
| 1654 | However, some or all of the text chunks may be after the image, so, to |
| 1655 | make sure you have read all the text chunks, don't mess with these |
| 1656 | until after you read the stuff after the image. This will be |
| 1657 | mentioned again below in the discussion that goes with png_read_end(). |
| 1658 | |
| 1659 | Input transformations |
| 1660 | |
| 1661 | After you've read the header information, you can set up the library |
| 1662 | to handle any special transformations of the image data. The various |
| 1663 | ways to transform the data will be described in the order that they |
| 1664 | should occur. This is important, as some of these change the color |
| 1665 | type and/or bit depth of the data, and some others only work on |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1666 | certain color types and bit depths. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1667 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1668 | Transformations you request are ignored if they don't have any meaning for a |
| 1669 | particular input data format. However some transformations can have an effect |
| 1670 | as a result of a previous transformation. If you specify a contradictory set of |
| 1671 | transformations, for example both adding and removing the alpha channel, you |
| 1672 | cannot predict the final result. |
| 1673 | |
| 1674 | The color used for the transparency values should be supplied in the same |
| 1675 | format/depth as the current image data. It is stored in the same format/depth |
| 1676 | as the image data in a tRNS chunk, so this is what libpng expects for this data. |
| 1677 | |
| 1678 | The color used for the background value depends on the need_expand argument as |
| 1679 | described below. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1680 | |
| 1681 | Data will be decoded into the supplied row buffers packed into bytes |
| 1682 | unless the library has been told to transform it into another format. |
| 1683 | For example, 4 bit/pixel paletted or grayscale data will be returned |
| 1684 | 2 pixels/byte with the leftmost pixel in the high-order bits of the |
| 1685 | byte, unless png_set_packing() is called. 8-bit RGB data will be stored |
| 1686 | in RGB RGB RGB format unless png_set_filler() or png_set_add_alpha() |
| 1687 | is called to insert filler bytes, either before or after each RGB triplet. |
| 1688 | 16-bit RGB data will be returned RRGGBB RRGGBB, with the most significant |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1689 | byte of the color value first, unless png_set_scale_16() is called to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1690 | transform it to regular RGB RGB triplets, or png_set_filler() or |
| 1691 | png_set_add alpha() is called to insert filler bytes, either before or |
| 1692 | after each RRGGBB triplet. Similarly, 8-bit or 16-bit grayscale data can |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1693 | be modified with png_set_filler(), png_set_add_alpha(), png_set_strip_16(), |
| 1694 | or png_set_scale_16(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1695 | |
| 1696 | The following code transforms grayscale images of less than 8 to 8 bits, |
| 1697 | changes paletted images to RGB, and adds a full alpha channel if there is |
| 1698 | transparency information in a tRNS chunk. This is most useful on |
| 1699 | grayscale images with bit depths of 2 or 4 or if there is a multiple-image |
| 1700 | viewing application that wishes to treat all images in the same way. |
| 1701 | |
| 1702 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE) |
| 1703 | png_set_palette_to_rgb(png_ptr); |
| 1704 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1705 | if (png_get_valid(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
| 1706 | PNG_INFO_tRNS)) png_set_tRNS_to_alpha(png_ptr); |
| 1707 | |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1708 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY && |
| 1709 | bit_depth < 8) png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8(png_ptr); |
| 1710 | |
| 1711 | The first two functions are actually aliases for png_set_expand(), added |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1712 | in libpng version 1.0.4, with the function names expanded to improve code |
| 1713 | readability. In some future version they may actually do different |
| 1714 | things. |
| 1715 | |
| 1716 | As of libpng version 1.2.9, png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8() was |
| 1717 | added. It expands the sample depth without changing tRNS to alpha. |
| 1718 | |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1719 | As of libpng version 1.5.2, png_set_expand_16() was added. It behaves as |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1720 | png_set_expand(); however, the resultant channels have 16 bits rather than 8. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36bb79 | 2011-02-12 09:49:07 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1721 | Use this when the output color or gray channels are made linear to avoid fairly |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1722 | severe accuracy loss. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1723 | |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1724 | if (bit_depth < 16) |
| 1725 | png_set_expand_16(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1726 | |
| 1727 | PNG can have files with 16 bits per channel. If you only can handle |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1728 | 8 bits per channel, this will strip the pixels down to 8-bit. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1729 | |
| 1730 | if (bit_depth == 16) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1731 | #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1732 | png_set_scale_16(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1733 | #else |
| 1734 | png_set_strip_16(png_ptr); |
| 1735 | #endif |
| 1736 | |
| 1737 | (The more accurate "png_set_scale_16()" API became available in libpng version |
| 1738 | 1.5.4). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1739 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1740 | If you need to process the alpha channel on the image separately from the image |
| 1741 | data (for example if you convert it to a bitmap mask) it is possible to have |
| 1742 | libpng strip the channel leaving just RGB or gray data: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1743 | |
| 1744 | if (color_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1745 | png_set_strip_alpha(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1746 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1747 | If you strip the alpha channel you need to find some other way of dealing with |
| 1748 | the information. If, instead, you want to convert the image to an opaque |
| 1749 | version with no alpha channel use png_set_background; see below. |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1750 | |
| 1751 | As of libpng version 1.5.2, almost all useful expansions are supported, the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cd116fa | 2011-05-17 06:56:50 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1752 | major ommissions are conversion of grayscale to indexed images (which can be |
| 1753 | done trivially in the application) and conversion of indexed to grayscale (which |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1754 | can be done by a trivial manipulation of the palette.) |
| 1755 | |
| 1756 | In the following table, the 01 means grayscale with depth<8, 31 means |
| 1757 | indexed with depth<8, other numerals represent the color type, "T" means |
| 1758 | the tRNS chunk is present, A means an alpha channel is present, and O |
| 1759 | means tRNS or alpha is present but all pixels in the image are opaque. |
| 1760 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36bb79 | 2011-02-12 09:49:07 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1761 | FROM 01 31 0 0T 0O 2 2T 2O 3 3T 3O 4A 4O 6A 6O |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1762 | TO |
| 1763 | 01 - [G] - - - - - - - - - - - - - |
| 1764 | 31 [Q] Q [Q] [Q] [Q] Q Q Q Q Q Q [Q] [Q] Q Q |
| 1765 | 0 1 G + . . G G G G G G B B GB GB |
| 1766 | 0T lt Gt t + . Gt G G Gt G G Bt Bt GBt GBt |
| 1767 | 0O lt Gt t . + Gt Gt G Gt Gt G Bt Bt GBt GBt |
| 1768 | 2 C P C C C + . . C - - CB CB B B |
| 1769 | 2T Ct - Ct C C t + t - - - CBt CBt Bt Bt |
| 1770 | 2O Ct - Ct C C t t + - - - CBt CBt Bt Bt |
| 1771 | 3 [Q] p [Q] [Q] [Q] Q Q Q + . . [Q] [Q] Q Q |
| 1772 | 3T [Qt] p [Qt][Q] [Q] Qt Qt Qt t + t [Qt][Qt] Qt Qt |
| 1773 | 3O [Qt] p [Qt][Q] [Q] Qt Qt Qt t t + [Qt][Qt] Qt Qt |
| 1774 | 4A lA G A T T GA GT GT GA GT GT + BA G GBA |
| 1775 | 4O lA GBA A T T GA GT GT GA GT GT BA + GBA G |
| 1776 | 6A CA PA CA C C A T tT PA P P C CBA + BA |
| 1777 | 6O CA PBA CA C C A tT T PA P P CBA C BA + |
| 1778 | |
| 1779 | Within the matrix, |
| 1780 | "+" identifies entries where 'from' and 'to' are the same. |
| 1781 | "-" means the transformation is not supported. |
| 1782 | "." means nothing is necessary (a tRNS chunk can just be ignored). |
| 1783 | "t" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_tRNS. |
| 1784 | "A" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_add_alpha(). |
| 1785 | "X" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_expand(). |
| 1786 | "1" means the transformation is obtained by |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1787 | png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8() (and by png_set_expand() |
| 1788 | if there is no transparency in the original or the final |
| 1789 | format). |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1790 | "C" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_gray_to_rgb(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36074e | 2011-05-16 09:08:51 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1791 | "G" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_rgb_to_gray(). |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1792 | "P" means the transformation is obtained by |
| 1793 | png_set_expand_palette_to_rgb(). |
| 1794 | "p" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_packing(). |
| 1795 | "Q" means the transformation is obtained by png_set_quantize(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1796 | "T" means the transformation is obtained by |
| 1797 | png_set_tRNS_to_alpha(). |
| 1798 | "B" means the transformation is obtained by |
| 1799 | png_set_background(), or png_strip_alpha(). |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1800 | |
| 1801 | When an entry has multiple transforms listed all are required to cause the |
| 1802 | right overall transformation. When two transforms are separated by a comma |
| 1803 | either will do the job. When transforms are enclosed in [] the transform should |
| 1804 | do the job but this is currently unimplemented - a different format will result |
| 1805 | if the suggested transformations are used. |
| 1806 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1807 | In PNG files, the alpha channel in an image |
| 1808 | is the level of opacity. If you need the alpha channel in an image to |
| 1809 | be the level of transparency instead of opacity, you can invert the |
| 1810 | alpha channel (or the tRNS chunk data) after it's read, so that 0 is |
| 1811 | fully opaque and 255 (in 8-bit or paletted images) or 65535 (in 16-bit |
| 1812 | images) is fully transparent, with |
| 1813 | |
| 1814 | png_set_invert_alpha(png_ptr); |
| 1815 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1816 | PNG files pack pixels of bit depths 1, 2, and 4 into bytes as small as |
| 1817 | they can, resulting in, for example, 8 pixels per byte for 1 bit |
| 1818 | files. This code expands to 1 pixel per byte without changing the |
| 1819 | values of the pixels: |
| 1820 | |
| 1821 | if (bit_depth < 8) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1822 | png_set_packing(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1823 | |
| 1824 | PNG files have possible bit depths of 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16. All pixels |
| 1825 | stored in a PNG image have been "scaled" or "shifted" up to the next |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1826 | higher possible bit depth (e.g. from 5 bits/sample in the range [0,31] |
| 1827 | to 8 bits/sample in the range [0, 255]). However, it is also possible |
| 1828 | to convert the PNG pixel data back to the original bit depth of the |
| 1829 | image. This call reduces the pixels back down to the original bit depth: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1830 | |
| 1831 | png_color_8p sig_bit; |
| 1832 | |
| 1833 | if (png_get_sBIT(png_ptr, info_ptr, &sig_bit)) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1834 | png_set_shift(png_ptr, sig_bit); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1835 | |
| 1836 | PNG files store 3-color pixels in red, green, blue order. This code |
| 1837 | changes the storage of the pixels to blue, green, red: |
| 1838 | |
| 1839 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB || |
| 1840 | color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1841 | png_set_bgr(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1842 | |
| 1843 | PNG files store RGB pixels packed into 3 or 6 bytes. This code expands them |
| 1844 | into 4 or 8 bytes for windowing systems that need them in this format: |
| 1845 | |
| 1846 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1847 | png_set_filler(png_ptr, filler, PNG_FILLER_BEFORE); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1848 | |
| 1849 | where "filler" is the 8 or 16-bit number to fill with, and the location is |
| 1850 | either PNG_FILLER_BEFORE or PNG_FILLER_AFTER, depending upon whether |
| 1851 | you want the filler before the RGB or after. This transformation |
| 1852 | does not affect images that already have full alpha channels. To add an |
| 1853 | opaque alpha channel, use filler=0xff or 0xffff and PNG_FILLER_AFTER which |
| 1854 | will generate RGBA pixels. |
| 1855 | |
| 1856 | Note that png_set_filler() does not change the color type. If you want |
| 1857 | to do that, you can add a true alpha channel with |
| 1858 | |
| 1859 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB || |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1860 | color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY) |
| 1861 | png_set_add_alpha(png_ptr, filler, PNG_FILLER_AFTER); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1862 | |
| 1863 | where "filler" contains the alpha value to assign to each pixel. |
| 1864 | This function was added in libpng-1.2.7. |
| 1865 | |
| 1866 | If you are reading an image with an alpha channel, and you need the |
| 1867 | data as ARGB instead of the normal PNG format RGBA: |
| 1868 | |
| 1869 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1870 | png_set_swap_alpha(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1871 | |
| 1872 | For some uses, you may want a grayscale image to be represented as |
| 1873 | RGB. This code will do that conversion: |
| 1874 | |
| 1875 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY || |
| 1876 | color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1877 | png_set_gray_to_rgb(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1878 | |
| 1879 | Conversely, you can convert an RGB or RGBA image to grayscale or grayscale |
| 1880 | with alpha. |
| 1881 | |
| 1882 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB || |
| 1883 | color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1884 | png_set_rgb_to_gray(png_ptr, error_action, |
| 1885 | double red_weight, double green_weight); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1886 | |
| 1887 | error_action = 1: silently do the conversion |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1888 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1889 | error_action = 2: issue a warning if the original |
| 1890 | image has any pixel where |
| 1891 | red != green or red != blue |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1892 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1893 | error_action = 3: issue an error and abort the |
| 1894 | conversion if the original |
| 1895 | image has any pixel where |
| 1896 | red != green or red != blue |
| 1897 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1898 | red_weight: weight of red component |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1899 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1900 | green_weight: weight of green component |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1901 | If either weight is negative, default |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1902 | weights are used. |
| 1903 | |
| 1904 | In the corresponding fixed point API the red_weight and green_weight values are |
| 1905 | simply scaled by 100,000: |
| 1906 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1907 | png_set_rgb_to_gray(png_ptr, error_action, |
| 1908 | png_fixed_point red_weight, |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1909 | png_fixed_point green_weight); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1910 | |
| 1911 | If you have set error_action = 1 or 2, you can |
| 1912 | later check whether the image really was gray, after processing |
| 1913 | the image rows, with the png_get_rgb_to_gray_status(png_ptr) function. |
| 1914 | It will return a png_byte that is zero if the image was gray or |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1915 | 1 if there were any non-gray pixels. Background and sBIT data |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1916 | will be silently converted to grayscale, using the green channel |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1917 | data for sBIT, regardless of the error_action setting. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1918 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1919 | The default values come from the PNG file cHRM chunk if present; otherwise, the |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1920 | defaults correspond to the ITU-R recommendation 709, and also the sRGB color |
| 1921 | space, as recommended in the Charles Poynton's Colour FAQ, |
| 1922 | <http://www.poynton.com/>, in section 9: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1923 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1924 | <http://www.poynton.com/notes/colour_and_gamma/ColorFAQ.html#RTFToC9> |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1925 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6c98897 | 2011-07-29 12:31:16 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1926 | Y = 0.2126 * R + 0.7152 * G + 0.0722 * B |
| 1927 | |
| 1928 | Previous versions of this document, 1998 through 2002, recommended a slightly |
| 1929 | different formula: |
| 1930 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1931 | Y = 0.212671 * R + 0.715160 * G + 0.072169 * B |
| 1932 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6c98897 | 2011-07-29 12:31:16 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1933 | Libpng uses an integer approximation: |
| 1934 | |
| 1935 | Y = (6968 * R + 23434 * G + 2366 * B)/32768 |
| 1936 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1937 | The calculation is done in a linear colorspace, if the image gamma |
John Bowler | f21a0d0 | 2011-01-23 23:55:19 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1938 | can be determined. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1939 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1940 | The png_set_background() function has been described already; it tells libpng to |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1941 | composite images with alpha or simple transparency against the supplied |
| 1942 | background color. For compatibility with versions of libpng earlier than |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1943 | libpng-1.5.4 it is recommended that you call the function after reading the file |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1944 | header, even if you don't want to use the color in a bKGD chunk, if one exists. |
| 1945 | |
| 1946 | If the PNG file contains a bKGD chunk (PNG_INFO_bKGD valid), |
| 1947 | you may use this color, or supply another color more suitable for |
| 1948 | the current display (e.g., the background color from a web page). You |
| 1949 | need to tell libpng how the color is represented, both the format of the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1950 | component values in the color (the number of bits) and the gamma encoding of the |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1951 | color. The function takes two arguments, background_gamma_mode and need_expand |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1952 | to convey this information; however, only two combinations are likely to be |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1953 | useful: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1954 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cb47e20 | 2011-07-10 06:55:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1955 | png_color_16 my_background; |
| 1956 | png_color_16p image_background; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1957 | |
| 1958 | if (png_get_bKGD(png_ptr, info_ptr, &image_background)) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1959 | png_set_background(png_ptr, image_background, |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1960 | PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE, 1/*needs to be expanded*/, 1); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1961 | else |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cb47e20 | 2011-07-10 06:55:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1962 | png_set_background(png_ptr, &my_background, |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1963 | PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN, 0/*do not expand*/, 1); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1964 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1965 | The second call was described above - my_background is in the format of the |
| 1966 | final, display, output produced by libpng. Because you now know the format of |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1967 | the PNG it is possible to avoid the need to choose either 8-bit or 16-bit |
| 1968 | output and to retain palette images (the palette colors will be modified |
| 1969 | appropriately and the tRNS chunk removed.) However, if you are doing this, |
| 1970 | take great care not to ask for transformations without checking first that |
| 1971 | they apply! |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1972 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1973 | In the first call the background color has the original bit depth and color type |
| 1974 | of the PNG file. So, for palette images the color is supplied as a palette |
| 1975 | index and for low bit greyscale images the color is a reduced bit value in |
| 1976 | image_background->gray. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1977 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1978 | If you didn't call png_set_gamma() before reading the file header, for example |
| 1979 | if you need your code to remain compatible with older versions of libpng prior |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1980 | to libpng-1.5.4, this is the place to call it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1981 | |
John Bowler | cb0b296 | 2011-05-12 21:48:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1982 | Do not call it if you called png_set_alpha_mode(); doing so will damage the |
| 1983 | settings put in place by png_set_alpha_mode(). (If png_set_alpha_mode() is |
| 1984 | supported then you can certainly do png_set_gamma() before reading the PNG |
| 1985 | header.) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1986 | |
John Bowler | d273ad2 | 2011-05-07 21:00:28 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1987 | This API unconditionally sets the screen and file gamma values, so it will |
| 1988 | override the value in the PNG file unless it is called before the PNG file |
| 1989 | reading starts. For this reason you must always call it with the PNG file |
| 1990 | value when you call it in this position: |
| 1991 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1992 | if (png_get_gAMA(png_ptr, info_ptr, &file_gamma)) |
| 1993 | png_set_gamma(png_ptr, screen_gamma, file_gamma); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 1994 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1995 | else |
| 1996 | png_set_gamma(png_ptr, screen_gamma, 0.45455); |
| 1997 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 1998 | If you need to reduce an RGB file to a paletted file, or if a paletted |
| 1999 | file has more entries then will fit on your screen, png_set_quantize() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 862cb20 | 2010-04-16 22:12:51 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2000 | will do that. Note that this is a simple match quantization that merely |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2001 | finds the closest color available. This should work fairly well with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2002 | optimized palettes, but fairly badly with linear color cubes. If you |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2003 | pass a palette that is larger than maximum_colors, the file will |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2004 | reduce the number of colors in the palette so it will fit into |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2005 | maximum_colors. If there is a histogram, libpng will use it to make |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2006 | more intelligent choices when reducing the palette. If there is no |
| 2007 | histogram, it may not do as good a job. |
| 2008 | |
| 2009 | if (color_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) |
| 2010 | { |
| 2011 | if (png_get_valid(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2012 | PNG_INFO_PLTE)) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2013 | { |
| 2014 | png_uint_16p histogram = NULL; |
| 2015 | |
| 2016 | png_get_hIST(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2017 | &histogram); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2018 | png_set_quantize(png_ptr, palette, num_palette, |
| 2019 | max_screen_colors, histogram, 1); |
| 2020 | } |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2021 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2022 | else |
| 2023 | { |
| 2024 | png_color std_color_cube[MAX_SCREEN_COLORS] = |
| 2025 | { ... colors ... }; |
| 2026 | |
| 2027 | png_set_quantize(png_ptr, std_color_cube, |
| 2028 | MAX_SCREEN_COLORS, MAX_SCREEN_COLORS, |
| 2029 | NULL,0); |
| 2030 | } |
| 2031 | } |
| 2032 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2033 | PNG files describe monochrome as black being zero and white being one. |
| 2034 | The following code will reverse this (make black be one and white be |
| 2035 | zero): |
| 2036 | |
| 2037 | if (bit_depth == 1 && color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY) |
| 2038 | png_set_invert_mono(png_ptr); |
| 2039 | |
| 2040 | This function can also be used to invert grayscale and gray-alpha images: |
| 2041 | |
| 2042 | if (color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY || |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2043 | color_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2044 | png_set_invert_mono(png_ptr); |
| 2045 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2046 | PNG files store 16-bit pixels in network byte order (big-endian, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2047 | ie. most significant bits first). This code changes the storage to the |
| 2048 | other way (little-endian, i.e. least significant bits first, the |
| 2049 | way PCs store them): |
| 2050 | |
| 2051 | if (bit_depth == 16) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2052 | png_set_swap(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2053 | |
| 2054 | If you are using packed-pixel images (1, 2, or 4 bits/pixel), and you |
| 2055 | need to change the order the pixels are packed into bytes, you can use: |
| 2056 | |
| 2057 | if (bit_depth < 8) |
| 2058 | png_set_packswap(png_ptr); |
| 2059 | |
| 2060 | Finally, you can write your own transformation function if none of |
| 2061 | the existing ones meets your needs. This is done by setting a callback |
| 2062 | with |
| 2063 | |
| 2064 | png_set_read_user_transform_fn(png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2065 | read_transform_fn); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2066 | |
| 2067 | You must supply the function |
| 2068 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9321567 | 2011-02-13 19:42:19 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2069 | void read_transform_fn(png_structp png_ptr, png_row_infop |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2070 | row_info, png_bytep data) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2071 | |
| 2072 | See pngtest.c for a working example. Your function will be called |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2073 | after all of the other transformations have been processed. Take care with |
| 2074 | interlaced images if you do the interlace yourself - the width of the row is the |
| 2075 | width in 'row_info', not the overall image width. |
| 2076 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2077 | If supported, libpng provides two information routines that you can use to find |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2078 | where you are in processing the image: |
| 2079 | |
| 2080 | png_get_current_pass_number(png_structp png_ptr); |
| 2081 | png_get_current_row_number(png_structp png_ptr); |
| 2082 | |
| 2083 | Don't try using these outside a transform callback - firstly they are only |
| 2084 | supported if user transforms are supported, secondly they may well return |
| 2085 | unexpected results unless the row is actually being processed at the moment they |
| 2086 | are called. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2087 | |
John Bowler | cd11345 | 2011-02-16 06:15:13 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2088 | With interlaced |
| 2089 | images the value returned is the row in the input sub-image image. Use |
| 2090 | PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(row, pass) and PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(col, pass) to |
| 2091 | find the output pixel (x,y) given an interlaced sub-image pixel (row,col,pass). |
| 2092 | |
| 2093 | The discussion of interlace handling above contains more information on how to |
| 2094 | use these values. |
| 2095 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2096 | You can also set up a pointer to a user structure for use by your |
| 2097 | callback function, and you can inform libpng that your transform |
| 2098 | function will change the number of channels or bit depth with the |
| 2099 | function |
| 2100 | |
| 2101 | png_set_user_transform_info(png_ptr, user_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2102 | user_depth, user_channels); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2103 | |
| 2104 | The user's application, not libpng, is responsible for allocating and |
| 2105 | freeing any memory required for the user structure. |
| 2106 | |
| 2107 | You can retrieve the pointer via the function |
| 2108 | png_get_user_transform_ptr(). For example: |
| 2109 | |
| 2110 | voidp read_user_transform_ptr = |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2111 | png_get_user_transform_ptr(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2112 | |
| 2113 | The last thing to handle is interlacing; this is covered in detail below, |
| 2114 | but you must call the function here if you want libpng to handle expansion |
| 2115 | of the interlaced image. |
| 2116 | |
| 2117 | number_of_passes = png_set_interlace_handling(png_ptr); |
| 2118 | |
| 2119 | After setting the transformations, libpng can update your png_info |
| 2120 | structure to reflect any transformations you've requested with this |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 968c231 | 2011-09-26 16:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2121 | call. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2122 | |
| 2123 | png_read_update_info(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 2124 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 968c231 | 2011-09-26 16:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2125 | This is most useful to update the info structure's rowbytes |
| 2126 | field so you can use it to allocate your image memory. This function |
| 2127 | will also update your palette with the correct screen_gamma and |
| 2128 | background if these have been given with the calls above. You may |
| 2129 | only call png_read_update_info() once with a particular info_ptr. |
| 2130 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2131 | After you call png_read_update_info(), you can allocate any |
| 2132 | memory you need to hold the image. The row data is simply |
| 2133 | raw byte data for all forms of images. As the actual allocation |
| 2134 | varies among applications, no example will be given. If you |
| 2135 | are allocating one large chunk, you will need to build an |
| 2136 | array of pointers to each row, as it will be needed for some |
| 2137 | of the functions below. |
| 2138 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 968c231 | 2011-09-26 16:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2139 | Remember: Before you call png_read_update_info(), the png_get_*() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2140 | functions return the values corresponding to the original PNG image. |
| 2141 | After you call png_read_update_info the values refer to the image |
| 2142 | that libpng will output. Consequently you must call all the png_set_ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2143 | functions before you call png_read_update_info(). This is particularly |
| 2144 | important for png_set_interlace_handling() - if you are going to call |
| 2145 | png_read_update_info() you must call png_set_interlace_handling() before |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2146 | it unless you want to receive interlaced output. |
| 2147 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2148 | Reading image data |
| 2149 | |
| 2150 | After you've allocated memory, you can read the image data. |
| 2151 | The simplest way to do this is in one function call. If you are |
| 2152 | allocating enough memory to hold the whole image, you can just |
| 2153 | call png_read_image() and libpng will read in all the image data |
| 2154 | and put it in the memory area supplied. You will need to pass in |
| 2155 | an array of pointers to each row. |
| 2156 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2157 | This function automatically handles interlacing, so you don't |
| 2158 | need to call png_set_interlace_handling() (unless you call |
| 2159 | png_read_update_info()) or call this function multiple times, or any |
| 2160 | of that other stuff necessary with png_read_rows(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2161 | |
| 2162 | png_read_image(png_ptr, row_pointers); |
| 2163 | |
| 2164 | where row_pointers is: |
| 2165 | |
| 2166 | png_bytep row_pointers[height]; |
| 2167 | |
| 2168 | You can point to void or char or whatever you use for pixels. |
| 2169 | |
| 2170 | If you don't want to read in the whole image at once, you can |
| 2171 | use png_read_rows() instead. If there is no interlacing (check |
| 2172 | interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_NONE), this is simple: |
| 2173 | |
| 2174 | png_read_rows(png_ptr, row_pointers, NULL, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2175 | number_of_rows); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2176 | |
| 2177 | where row_pointers is the same as in the png_read_image() call. |
| 2178 | |
| 2179 | If you are doing this just one row at a time, you can do this with |
| 2180 | a single row_pointer instead of an array of row_pointers: |
| 2181 | |
| 2182 | png_bytep row_pointer = row; |
| 2183 | png_read_row(png_ptr, row_pointer, NULL); |
| 2184 | |
| 2185 | If the file is interlaced (interlace_type != 0 in the IHDR chunk), things |
| 2186 | get somewhat harder. The only current (PNG Specification version 1.2) |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2187 | interlacing type for PNG is (interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7); |
| 2188 | a somewhat complicated 2D interlace scheme, known as Adam7, that |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2189 | breaks down an image into seven smaller images of varying size, based |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2190 | on an 8x8 grid. This number is defined (from libpng 1.5) as |
| 2191 | PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES in png.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2192 | |
| 2193 | libpng can fill out those images or it can give them to you "as is". |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2194 | It is almost always better to have libpng handle the interlacing for you. |
| 2195 | If you want the images filled out, there are two ways to do that. The one |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2196 | mentioned in the PNG specification is to expand each pixel to cover |
| 2197 | those pixels that have not been read yet (the "rectangle" method). |
| 2198 | This results in a blocky image for the first pass, which gradually |
| 2199 | smooths out as more pixels are read. The other method is the "sparkle" |
| 2200 | method, where pixels are drawn only in their final locations, with the |
| 2201 | rest of the image remaining whatever colors they were initialized to |
| 2202 | before the start of the read. The first method usually looks better, |
| 2203 | but tends to be slower, as there are more pixels to put in the rows. |
| 2204 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2205 | If, as is likely, you want libpng to expand the images, call this before |
| 2206 | calling png_start_read_image() or png_read_update_info(): |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2207 | |
| 2208 | if (interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2209 | number_of_passes |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2210 | = png_set_interlace_handling(png_ptr); |
| 2211 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2212 | This will return the number of passes needed. Currently, this is seven, |
| 2213 | but may change if another interlace type is added. This function can be |
| 2214 | called even if the file is not interlaced, where it will return one pass. |
| 2215 | You then need to read the whole image 'number_of_passes' times. Each time |
| 2216 | will distribute the pixels from the current pass to the correct place in |
| 2217 | the output image, so you need to supply the same rows to png_read_rows in |
| 2218 | each pass. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2219 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2220 | If you are not going to display the image after each pass, but are |
| 2221 | going to wait until the entire image is read in, use the sparkle |
| 2222 | effect. This effect is faster and the end result of either method |
| 2223 | is exactly the same. If you are planning on displaying the image |
| 2224 | after each pass, the "rectangle" effect is generally considered the |
| 2225 | better looking one. |
| 2226 | |
| 2227 | If you only want the "sparkle" effect, just call png_read_rows() as |
| 2228 | normal, with the third parameter NULL. Make sure you make pass over |
| 2229 | the image number_of_passes times, and you don't change the data in the |
| 2230 | rows between calls. You can change the locations of the data, just |
| 2231 | not the data. Each pass only writes the pixels appropriate for that |
| 2232 | pass, and assumes the data from previous passes is still valid. |
| 2233 | |
| 2234 | png_read_rows(png_ptr, row_pointers, NULL, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2235 | number_of_rows); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2236 | |
| 2237 | If you only want the first effect (the rectangles), do the same as |
| 2238 | before except pass the row buffer in the third parameter, and leave |
| 2239 | the second parameter NULL. |
| 2240 | |
| 2241 | png_read_rows(png_ptr, NULL, row_pointers, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2242 | number_of_rows); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2243 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2244 | If you don't want libpng to handle the interlacing details, just call |
| 2245 | png_read_rows() PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES times to read in all the images. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2246 | Each of the images is a valid image by itself; however, you will almost |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2247 | certainly need to distribute the pixels from each sub-image to the |
| 2248 | correct place. This is where everything gets very tricky. |
| 2249 | |
| 2250 | If you want to retrieve the separate images you must pass the correct |
| 2251 | number of rows to each successive call of png_read_rows(). The calculation |
| 2252 | gets pretty complicated for small images, where some sub-images may |
| 2253 | not even exist because either their width or height ends up zero. |
| 2254 | libpng provides two macros to help you in 1.5 and later versions: |
| 2255 | |
| 2256 | png_uint_32 width = PNG_PASS_COLS(image_width, pass_number); |
| 2257 | png_uint_32 height = PNG_PASS_ROWS(image_height, pass_number); |
| 2258 | |
| 2259 | Respectively these tell you the width and height of the sub-image |
| 2260 | corresponding to the numbered pass. 'pass' is in in the range 0 to 6 - |
| 2261 | this can be confusing because the specification refers to the same passes |
| 2262 | as 1 to 7! Be careful, you must check both the width and height before |
| 2263 | calling png_read_rows() and not call it for that pass if either is zero. |
| 2264 | |
| 2265 | You can, of course, read each sub-image row by row. If you want to |
| 2266 | produce optimal code to make a pixel-by-pixel transformation of an |
| 2267 | interlaced image this is the best approach; read each row of each pass, |
| 2268 | transform it, and write it out to a new interlaced image. |
| 2269 | |
| 2270 | If you want to de-interlace the image yourself libpng provides further |
| 2271 | macros to help that tell you where to place the pixels in the output image. |
| 2272 | Because the interlacing scheme is rectangular - sub-image pixels are always |
| 2273 | arranged on a rectangular grid - all you need to know for each pass is the |
| 2274 | starting column and row in the output image of the first pixel plus the |
| 2275 | spacing between each pixel. As of libpng 1.5 there are four macros to |
| 2276 | retrieve this information: |
| 2277 | |
| 2278 | png_uint_32 x = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass); |
| 2279 | png_uint_32 y = PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass); |
| 2280 | png_uint_32 xStep = 1U << PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass); |
| 2281 | png_uint_32 yStep = 1U << PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass); |
| 2282 | |
| 2283 | These allow you to write the obvious loop: |
| 2284 | |
| 2285 | png_uint_32 input_y = 0; |
| 2286 | png_uint_32 output_y = PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass); |
| 2287 | |
| 2288 | while (output_y < output_image_height) |
| 2289 | { |
| 2290 | png_uint_32 input_x = 0; |
| 2291 | png_uint_32 output_x = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass); |
| 2292 | |
| 2293 | while (output_x < output_image_width) |
| 2294 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2295 | image[output_y][output_x] = |
| 2296 | subimage[pass][input_y][input_x++]; |
| 2297 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2298 | output_x += xStep; |
| 2299 | } |
| 2300 | |
| 2301 | ++input_y; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2302 | output_y += yStep; |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2303 | } |
| 2304 | |
| 2305 | Notice that the steps between successive output rows and columns are |
| 2306 | returned as shifts. This is possible because the pixels in the subimages |
| 2307 | are always a power of 2 apart - 1, 2, 4 or 8 pixels - in the original |
| 2308 | image. In practice you may need to directly calculate the output coordinate |
| 2309 | given an input coordinate. libpng provides two further macros for this |
| 2310 | purpose: |
| 2311 | |
| 2312 | png_uint_32 output_x = PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(input_x, pass); |
| 2313 | png_uint_32 output_y = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(input_y, pass); |
| 2314 | |
| 2315 | Finally a pair of macros are provided to tell you if a particular image |
| 2316 | row or column appears in a given pass: |
| 2317 | |
| 2318 | int col_in_pass = PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(output_x, pass); |
| 2319 | int row_in_pass = PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(output_y, pass); |
| 2320 | |
| 2321 | Bear in mind that you will probably also need to check the width and height |
| 2322 | of the pass in addition to the above to be sure the pass even exists! |
| 2323 | |
| 2324 | With any luck you are convinced by now that you don't want to do your own |
| 2325 | interlace handling. In reality normally the only good reason for doing this |
| 2326 | is if you are processing PNG files on a pixel-by-pixel basis and don't want |
| 2327 | to load the whole file into memory when it is interlaced. |
| 2328 | |
| 2329 | libpng includes a test program, pngvalid, that illustrates reading and |
| 2330 | writing of interlaced images. If you can't get interlacing to work in your |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2331 | code and don't want to leave it to libpng (the recommended approach), see |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2332 | how pngvalid.c does it. |
| 2333 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2334 | Finishing a sequential read |
| 2335 | |
| 2336 | After you are finished reading the image through the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2337 | low-level interface, you can finish reading the file. |
| 2338 | |
| 2339 | If you want to use a different crc action for handling CRC errors in |
| 2340 | chunks after the image data, you can call png_set_crc_action() |
| 2341 | again at this point. |
| 2342 | |
| 2343 | If you are interested in comments or time, which may be stored either |
| 2344 | before or after the image data, you should pass the separate png_info |
| 2345 | struct if you want to keep the comments from before and after the image |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2346 | separate. |
| 2347 | |
| 2348 | png_infop end_info = png_create_info_struct(png_ptr); |
| 2349 | |
| 2350 | if (!end_info) |
| 2351 | { |
| 2352 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
| 2353 | (png_infopp)NULL); |
| 2354 | return (ERROR); |
| 2355 | } |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2356 | |
| 2357 | png_read_end(png_ptr, end_info); |
| 2358 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2359 | If you are not interested, you should still call png_read_end() |
| 2360 | but you can pass NULL, avoiding the need to create an end_info structure. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2361 | If you do this, libpng will not process any chunks after IDAT other than |
| 2362 | skipping over them and perhaps (depending on whether you have called |
| 2363 | png_set_crc_action) checking their CRCs while looking for the IEND chunk. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2364 | |
| 2365 | png_read_end(png_ptr, (png_infop)NULL); |
| 2366 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 99778e1 | 2011-04-20 17:43:52 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2367 | If you don't call png_read_end(), then your file pointer will be |
| 2368 | left pointing to the first chunk after the last IDAT, which is probably |
| 2369 | not what you want if you expect to read something beyond the end of |
| 2370 | the PNG datastream. |
| 2371 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2372 | When you are done, you can free all memory allocated by libpng like this: |
| 2373 | |
| 2374 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
| 2375 | &end_info); |
| 2376 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 20786be | 2011-04-20 22:20:40 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2377 | or, if you didn't create an end_info structure, |
| 2378 | |
| 2379 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
| 2380 | (png_infopp)NULL); |
| 2381 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2382 | It is also possible to individually free the info_ptr members that |
| 2383 | point to libpng-allocated storage with the following function: |
| 2384 | |
| 2385 | png_free_data(png_ptr, info_ptr, mask, seq) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2386 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2387 | mask - identifies data to be freed, a mask |
| 2388 | containing the bitwise OR of one or |
| 2389 | more of |
| 2390 | PNG_FREE_PLTE, PNG_FREE_TRNS, |
| 2391 | PNG_FREE_HIST, PNG_FREE_ICCP, |
| 2392 | PNG_FREE_PCAL, PNG_FREE_ROWS, |
| 2393 | PNG_FREE_SCAL, PNG_FREE_SPLT, |
| 2394 | PNG_FREE_TEXT, PNG_FREE_UNKN, |
| 2395 | or simply PNG_FREE_ALL |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2396 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2397 | seq - sequence number of item to be freed |
| 2398 | (-1 for all items) |
| 2399 | |
| 2400 | This function may be safely called when the relevant storage has |
| 2401 | already been freed, or has not yet been allocated, or was allocated |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2402 | by the user and not by libpng, and will in those cases do nothing. |
| 2403 | The "seq" parameter is ignored if only one item of the selected data |
| 2404 | type, such as PLTE, is allowed. If "seq" is not -1, and multiple items |
| 2405 | are allowed for the data type identified in the mask, such as text or |
| 2406 | sPLT, only the n'th item in the structure is freed, where n is "seq". |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2407 | |
| 2408 | The default behavior is only to free data that was allocated internally |
| 2409 | by libpng. This can be changed, so that libpng will not free the data, |
| 2410 | or so that it will free data that was allocated by the user with png_malloc() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2411 | or png_calloc() and passed in via a png_set_*() function, with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2412 | |
| 2413 | png_data_freer(png_ptr, info_ptr, freer, mask) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2414 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2415 | freer - one of |
| 2416 | PNG_DESTROY_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 2417 | PNG_SET_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 2418 | PNG_USER_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 2419 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2420 | mask - which data elements are affected |
| 2421 | same choices as in png_free_data() |
| 2422 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2423 | This function only affects data that has already been allocated. |
| 2424 | You can call this function after reading the PNG data but before calling |
| 2425 | any png_set_*() functions, to control whether the user or the png_set_*() |
| 2426 | function is responsible for freeing any existing data that might be present, |
| 2427 | and again after the png_set_*() functions to control whether the user |
| 2428 | or png_destroy_*() is supposed to free the data. When the user assumes |
| 2429 | responsibility for libpng-allocated data, the application must use |
| 2430 | png_free() to free it, and when the user transfers responsibility to libpng |
| 2431 | for data that the user has allocated, the user must have used png_malloc() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2432 | or png_calloc() to allocate it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2433 | |
| 2434 | If you allocated your row_pointers in a single block, as suggested above in |
| 2435 | the description of the high level read interface, you must not transfer |
| 2436 | responsibility for freeing it to the png_set_rows or png_read_destroy function, |
| 2437 | because they would also try to free the individual row_pointers[i]. |
| 2438 | |
| 2439 | If you allocated text_ptr.text, text_ptr.lang, and text_ptr.translated_keyword |
| 2440 | separately, do not transfer responsibility for freeing text_ptr to libpng, |
| 2441 | because when libpng fills a png_text structure it combines these members with |
| 2442 | the key member, and png_free_data() will free only text_ptr.key. Similarly, |
| 2443 | if you transfer responsibility for free'ing text_ptr from libpng to your |
| 2444 | application, your application must not separately free those members. |
| 2445 | |
| 2446 | The png_free_data() function will turn off the "valid" flag for anything |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2447 | it frees. If you need to turn the flag off for a chunk that was freed by |
| 2448 | your application instead of by libpng, you can use |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2449 | |
| 2450 | png_set_invalid(png_ptr, info_ptr, mask); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2451 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2452 | mask - identifies the chunks to be made invalid, |
| 2453 | containing the bitwise OR of one or |
| 2454 | more of |
| 2455 | PNG_INFO_gAMA, PNG_INFO_sBIT, |
| 2456 | PNG_INFO_cHRM, PNG_INFO_PLTE, |
| 2457 | PNG_INFO_tRNS, PNG_INFO_bKGD, |
| 2458 | PNG_INFO_hIST, PNG_INFO_pHYs, |
| 2459 | PNG_INFO_oFFs, PNG_INFO_tIME, |
| 2460 | PNG_INFO_pCAL, PNG_INFO_sRGB, |
| 2461 | PNG_INFO_iCCP, PNG_INFO_sPLT, |
| 2462 | PNG_INFO_sCAL, PNG_INFO_IDAT |
| 2463 | |
| 2464 | For a more compact example of reading a PNG image, see the file example.c. |
| 2465 | |
| 2466 | Reading PNG files progressively |
| 2467 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2468 | The progressive reader is slightly different from the non-progressive |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2469 | reader. Instead of calling png_read_info(), png_read_rows(), and |
| 2470 | png_read_end(), you make one call to png_process_data(), which calls |
| 2471 | callbacks when it has the info, a row, or the end of the image. You |
| 2472 | set up these callbacks with png_set_progressive_read_fn(). You don't |
| 2473 | have to worry about the input/output functions of libpng, as you are |
| 2474 | giving the library the data directly in png_process_data(). I will |
| 2475 | assume that you have read the section on reading PNG files above, |
| 2476 | so I will only highlight the differences (although I will show |
| 2477 | all of the code). |
| 2478 | |
| 2479 | png_structp png_ptr; |
| 2480 | png_infop info_ptr; |
| 2481 | |
| 2482 | /* An example code fragment of how you would |
| 2483 | initialize the progressive reader in your |
| 2484 | application. */ |
| 2485 | int |
| 2486 | initialize_png_reader() |
| 2487 | { |
| 2488 | png_ptr = png_create_read_struct |
| 2489 | (PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, (png_voidp)user_error_ptr, |
| 2490 | user_error_fn, user_warning_fn); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2491 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2492 | if (!png_ptr) |
| 2493 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2494 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2495 | info_ptr = png_create_info_struct(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2496 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2497 | if (!info_ptr) |
| 2498 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2499 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, |
| 2500 | (png_infopp)NULL, (png_infopp)NULL); |
| 2501 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2502 | } |
| 2503 | |
| 2504 | if (setjmp(png_jmpbuf(png_ptr))) |
| 2505 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2506 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
| 2507 | (png_infopp)NULL); |
| 2508 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2509 | } |
| 2510 | |
| 2511 | /* This one's new. You can provide functions |
| 2512 | to be called when the header info is valid, |
| 2513 | when each row is completed, and when the image |
| 2514 | is finished. If you aren't using all functions, |
| 2515 | you can specify NULL parameters. Even when all |
| 2516 | three functions are NULL, you need to call |
| 2517 | png_set_progressive_read_fn(). You can use |
| 2518 | any struct as the user_ptr (cast to a void pointer |
| 2519 | for the function call), and retrieve the pointer |
| 2520 | from inside the callbacks using the function |
| 2521 | |
| 2522 | png_get_progressive_ptr(png_ptr); |
| 2523 | |
| 2524 | which will return a void pointer, which you have |
| 2525 | to cast appropriately. |
| 2526 | */ |
| 2527 | png_set_progressive_read_fn(png_ptr, (void *)user_ptr, |
| 2528 | info_callback, row_callback, end_callback); |
| 2529 | |
| 2530 | return 0; |
| 2531 | } |
| 2532 | |
| 2533 | /* A code fragment that you call as you receive blocks |
| 2534 | of data */ |
| 2535 | int |
| 2536 | process_data(png_bytep buffer, png_uint_32 length) |
| 2537 | { |
| 2538 | if (setjmp(png_jmpbuf(png_ptr))) |
| 2539 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2540 | png_destroy_read_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2541 | (png_infopp)NULL); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2542 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2543 | } |
| 2544 | |
| 2545 | /* This one's new also. Simply give it a chunk |
| 2546 | of data from the file stream (in order, of |
| 2547 | course). On machines with segmented memory |
| 2548 | models machines, don't give it any more than |
| 2549 | 64K. The library seems to run fine with sizes |
| 2550 | of 4K. Although you can give it much less if |
| 2551 | necessary (I assume you can give it chunks of |
| 2552 | 1 byte, I haven't tried less then 256 bytes |
| 2553 | yet). When this function returns, you may |
| 2554 | want to display any rows that were generated |
| 2555 | in the row callback if you don't already do |
| 2556 | so there. |
| 2557 | */ |
| 2558 | png_process_data(png_ptr, info_ptr, buffer, length); |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2559 | |
| 2560 | /* At this point you can call png_process_data_skip if |
| 2561 | you want to handle data the library will skip yourself; |
| 2562 | it simply returns the number of bytes to skip (and stops |
| 2563 | libpng skipping that number of bytes on the next |
| 2564 | png_process_data call). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2565 | return 0; |
| 2566 | } |
| 2567 | |
| 2568 | /* This function is called (as set by |
| 2569 | png_set_progressive_read_fn() above) when enough data |
| 2570 | has been supplied so all of the header has been |
| 2571 | read. |
| 2572 | */ |
| 2573 | void |
| 2574 | info_callback(png_structp png_ptr, png_infop info) |
| 2575 | { |
| 2576 | /* Do any setup here, including setting any of |
| 2577 | the transformations mentioned in the Reading |
| 2578 | PNG files section. For now, you _must_ call |
| 2579 | either png_start_read_image() or |
| 2580 | png_read_update_info() after all the |
| 2581 | transformations are set (even if you don't set |
| 2582 | any). You may start getting rows before |
| 2583 | png_process_data() returns, so this is your |
| 2584 | last chance to prepare for that. |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2585 | |
| 2586 | This is where you turn on interlace handling, |
| 2587 | assuming you don't want to do it yourself. |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2588 | |
| 2589 | If you need to you can stop the processing of |
| 2590 | your original input data at this point by calling |
| 2591 | png_process_data_pause. This returns the number |
| 2592 | of unprocessed bytes from the last png_process_data |
| 2593 | call - it is up to you to ensure that the next call |
| 2594 | sees these bytes again. If you don't want to bother |
| 2595 | with this you can get libpng to cache the unread |
| 2596 | bytes by setting the 'save' parameter (see png.h) but |
| 2597 | then libpng will have to copy the data internally. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2598 | */ |
| 2599 | } |
| 2600 | |
| 2601 | /* This function is called when each row of image |
| 2602 | data is complete */ |
| 2603 | void |
| 2604 | row_callback(png_structp png_ptr, png_bytep new_row, |
| 2605 | png_uint_32 row_num, int pass) |
| 2606 | { |
| 2607 | /* If the image is interlaced, and you turned |
| 2608 | on the interlace handler, this function will |
| 2609 | be called for every row in every pass. Some |
| 2610 | of these rows will not be changed from the |
| 2611 | previous pass. When the row is not changed, |
| 2612 | the new_row variable will be NULL. The rows |
| 2613 | and passes are called in order, so you don't |
| 2614 | really need the row_num and pass, but I'm |
| 2615 | supplying them because it may make your life |
| 2616 | easier. |
| 2617 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2618 | If you did not turn on interlace handling then |
| 2619 | the callback is called for each row of each |
| 2620 | sub-image when the image is interlaced. In this |
| 2621 | case 'row_num' is the row in the sub-image, not |
| 2622 | the row in the output image as it is in all other |
| 2623 | cases. |
| 2624 | |
| 2625 | For the non-NULL rows of interlaced images when |
| 2626 | you have switched on libpng interlace handling, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2627 | you must call png_progressive_combine_row() |
| 2628 | passing in the row and the old row. You can |
| 2629 | call this function for NULL rows (it will just |
| 2630 | return) and for non-interlaced images (it just |
| 2631 | does the memcpy for you) if it will make the |
| 2632 | code easier. Thus, you can just do this for |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2633 | all cases if you switch on interlace handling; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2634 | */ |
| 2635 | |
| 2636 | png_progressive_combine_row(png_ptr, old_row, |
| 2637 | new_row); |
| 2638 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2639 | /* where old_row is what was displayed |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2640 | previously for the row. Note that the first |
| 2641 | pass (pass == 0, really) will completely cover |
| 2642 | the old row, so the rows do not have to be |
| 2643 | initialized. After the first pass (and only |
| 2644 | for interlaced images), you will have to pass |
| 2645 | the current row, and the function will combine |
| 2646 | the old row and the new row. |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2647 | |
| 2648 | You can also call png_process_data_pause in this |
| 2649 | callback - see above. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2650 | */ |
| 2651 | } |
| 2652 | |
| 2653 | void |
| 2654 | end_callback(png_structp png_ptr, png_infop info) |
| 2655 | { |
| 2656 | /* This function is called after the whole image |
| 2657 | has been read, including any chunks after the |
| 2658 | image (up to and including the IEND). You |
| 2659 | will usually have the same info chunk as you |
| 2660 | had in the header, although some data may have |
| 2661 | been added to the comments and time fields. |
| 2662 | |
| 2663 | Most people won't do much here, perhaps setting |
| 2664 | a flag that marks the image as finished. |
| 2665 | */ |
| 2666 | } |
| 2667 | |
| 2668 | |
| 2669 | |
| 2670 | IV. Writing |
| 2671 | |
| 2672 | Much of this is very similar to reading. However, everything of |
| 2673 | importance is repeated here, so you won't have to constantly look |
| 2674 | back up in the reading section to understand writing. |
| 2675 | |
| 2676 | Setup |
| 2677 | |
| 2678 | You will want to do the I/O initialization before you get into libpng, |
| 2679 | so if it doesn't work, you don't have anything to undo. If you are not |
| 2680 | using the standard I/O functions, you will need to replace them with |
| 2681 | custom writing functions. See the discussion under Customizing libpng. |
| 2682 | |
| 2683 | FILE *fp = fopen(file_name, "wb"); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2684 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2685 | if (!fp) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2686 | return (ERROR); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2687 | |
| 2688 | Next, png_struct and png_info need to be allocated and initialized. |
| 2689 | As these can be both relatively large, you may not want to store these |
| 2690 | on the stack, unless you have stack space to spare. Of course, you |
| 2691 | will want to check if they return NULL. If you are also reading, |
| 2692 | you won't want to name your read structure and your write structure |
| 2693 | both "png_ptr"; you can call them anything you like, such as |
| 2694 | "read_ptr" and "write_ptr". Look at pngtest.c, for example. |
| 2695 | |
| 2696 | png_structp png_ptr = png_create_write_struct |
| 2697 | (PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, (png_voidp)user_error_ptr, |
| 2698 | user_error_fn, user_warning_fn); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2699 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2700 | if (!png_ptr) |
| 2701 | return (ERROR); |
| 2702 | |
| 2703 | png_infop info_ptr = png_create_info_struct(png_ptr); |
| 2704 | if (!info_ptr) |
| 2705 | { |
| 2706 | png_destroy_write_struct(&png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2707 | (png_infopp)NULL); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2708 | return (ERROR); |
| 2709 | } |
| 2710 | |
| 2711 | If you want to use your own memory allocation routines, |
| 2712 | define PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED and use |
| 2713 | png_create_write_struct_2() instead of png_create_write_struct(): |
| 2714 | |
| 2715 | png_structp png_ptr = png_create_write_struct_2 |
| 2716 | (PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, (png_voidp)user_error_ptr, |
| 2717 | user_error_fn, user_warning_fn, (png_voidp) |
| 2718 | user_mem_ptr, user_malloc_fn, user_free_fn); |
| 2719 | |
| 2720 | After you have these structures, you will need to set up the |
| 2721 | error handling. When libpng encounters an error, it expects to |
| 2722 | longjmp() back to your routine. Therefore, you will need to call |
| 2723 | setjmp() and pass the png_jmpbuf(png_ptr). If you |
| 2724 | write the file from different routines, you will need to update |
| 2725 | the png_jmpbuf(png_ptr) every time you enter a new routine that will |
| 2726 | call a png_*() function. See your documentation of setjmp/longjmp |
| 2727 | for your compiler for more information on setjmp/longjmp. See |
| 2728 | the discussion on libpng error handling in the Customizing Libpng |
| 2729 | section below for more information on the libpng error handling. |
| 2730 | |
| 2731 | if (setjmp(png_jmpbuf(png_ptr))) |
| 2732 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2733 | png_destroy_write_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2734 | fclose(fp); |
| 2735 | return (ERROR); |
| 2736 | } |
| 2737 | ... |
| 2738 | return; |
| 2739 | |
| 2740 | If you would rather avoid the complexity of setjmp/longjmp issues, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2741 | you can compile libpng with PNG_NO_SETJMP, in which case |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2742 | errors will result in a call to PNG_ABORT() which defaults to abort(). |
| 2743 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2744 | You can #define PNG_ABORT() to a function that does something |
| 2745 | more useful than abort(), as long as your function does not |
| 2746 | return. |
| 2747 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2748 | Checking for invalid palette index on write was added at libpng |
| 2749 | 1.5.10. If a pixel contains an invalid (out-of-range) index libpng issues |
| 2750 | a benign error. This is enabled by default because this condition is an |
| 2751 | error according to the PNG specification, Clause 11.3.2, but the error can |
| 2752 | be ignored in each png_ptr with |
| 2753 | |
| 2754 | png_set_check_for_invalid_index(png_ptr, 0); |
| 2755 | |
| 2756 | If the error is ignored, or if png_benign_error() treats it as a warning, |
| 2757 | any invalid pixels are written as-is by the encoder, resulting in an |
| 2758 | invalid PNG datastream as output. In this case the application is |
| 2759 | responsible for ensuring that the pixel indexes are in range when it writes |
| 2760 | a PLTE chunk with fewer entries than the bit depth would allow. |
| 2761 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2762 | Now you need to set up the output code. The default for libpng is to |
| 2763 | use the C function fwrite(). If you use this, you will need to pass a |
| 2764 | valid FILE * in the function png_init_io(). Be sure that the file is |
| 2765 | opened in binary mode. Again, if you wish to handle writing data in |
| 2766 | another way, see the discussion on libpng I/O handling in the Customizing |
| 2767 | Libpng section below. |
| 2768 | |
| 2769 | png_init_io(png_ptr, fp); |
| 2770 | |
| 2771 | If you are embedding your PNG into a datastream such as MNG, and don't |
| 2772 | want libpng to write the 8-byte signature, or if you have already |
| 2773 | written the signature in your application, use |
| 2774 | |
| 2775 | png_set_sig_bytes(png_ptr, 8); |
| 2776 | |
| 2777 | to inform libpng that it should not write a signature. |
| 2778 | |
| 2779 | Write callbacks |
| 2780 | |
| 2781 | At this point, you can set up a callback function that will be |
| 2782 | called after each row has been written, which you can use to control |
| 2783 | a progress meter or the like. It's demonstrated in pngtest.c. |
| 2784 | You must supply a function |
| 2785 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 81ce889 | 2011-01-24 08:04:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2786 | void write_row_callback(png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 row, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2787 | int pass); |
| 2788 | { |
| 2789 | /* put your code here */ |
| 2790 | } |
| 2791 | |
| 2792 | (You can give it another name that you like instead of "write_row_callback") |
| 2793 | |
| 2794 | To inform libpng about your function, use |
| 2795 | |
| 2796 | png_set_write_status_fn(png_ptr, write_row_callback); |
| 2797 | |
John Bowler | 59010e5 | 2011-02-16 06:16:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2798 | When this function is called the row has already been completely processed and |
| 2799 | it has also been written out. The 'row' and 'pass' refer to the next row to be |
| 2800 | handled. For the |
| 2801 | non-interlaced case the row that was just handled is simply one less than the |
| 2802 | passed in row number, and pass will always be 0. For the interlaced case the |
| 2803 | same applies unless the row value is 0, in which case the row just handled was |
| 2804 | the last one from one of the preceding passes. Because interlacing may skip a |
| 2805 | pass you cannot be sure that the preceding pass is just 'pass-1', if you really |
| 2806 | need to know what the last pass is record (row,pass) from the callback and use |
| 2807 | the last recorded value each time. |
| 2808 | |
| 2809 | As with the user transform you can find the output row using the |
| 2810 | PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW macro. |
| 2811 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2812 | You now have the option of modifying how the compression library will |
| 2813 | run. The following functions are mainly for testing, but may be useful |
| 2814 | in some cases, like if you need to write PNG files extremely fast and |
| 2815 | are willing to give up some compression, or if you want to get the |
| 2816 | maximum possible compression at the expense of slower writing. If you |
| 2817 | have no special needs in this area, let the library do what it wants by |
| 2818 | not calling this function at all, as it has been tuned to deliver a good |
| 2819 | speed/compression ratio. The second parameter to png_set_filter() is |
| 2820 | the filter method, for which the only valid values are 0 (as of the |
| 2821 | July 1999 PNG specification, version 1.2) or 64 (if you are writing |
| 2822 | a PNG datastream that is to be embedded in a MNG datastream). The third |
| 2823 | parameter is a flag that indicates which filter type(s) are to be tested |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2824 | for each scanline. See the PNG specification for details on the specific |
| 2825 | filter types. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2826 | |
| 2827 | |
| 2828 | /* turn on or off filtering, and/or choose |
| 2829 | specific filters. You can use either a single |
| 2830 | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_NAME or the bitwise OR of one |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2831 | or more PNG_FILTER_NAME masks. |
| 2832 | */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2833 | png_set_filter(png_ptr, 0, |
| 2834 | PNG_FILTER_NONE | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_NONE | |
| 2835 | PNG_FILTER_SUB | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_SUB | |
| 2836 | PNG_FILTER_UP | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_UP | |
| 2837 | PNG_FILTER_AVG | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_AVG | |
| 2838 | PNG_FILTER_PAETH | PNG_FILTER_VALUE_PAETH| |
| 2839 | PNG_ALL_FILTERS); |
| 2840 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2841 | If an application wants to start and stop using particular filters during |
| 2842 | compression, it should start out with all of the filters (to ensure that |
| 2843 | the previous row of pixels will be stored in case it's needed later), |
| 2844 | and then add and remove them after the start of compression. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2845 | |
| 2846 | If you are writing a PNG datastream that is to be embedded in a MNG |
| 2847 | datastream, the second parameter can be either 0 or 64. |
| 2848 | |
| 2849 | The png_set_compression_*() functions interface to the zlib compression |
| 2850 | library, and should mostly be ignored unless you really know what you are |
| 2851 | doing. The only generally useful call is png_set_compression_level() |
| 2852 | which changes how much time zlib spends on trying to compress the image |
| 2853 | data. See the Compression Library (zlib.h and algorithm.txt, distributed |
| 2854 | with zlib) for details on the compression levels. |
| 2855 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 38734ee | 2011-03-03 06:23:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2856 | #include zlib.h |
| 2857 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a45f47c | 2011-04-01 15:31:26 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2858 | /* Set the zlib compression level */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2859 | png_set_compression_level(png_ptr, |
| 2860 | Z_BEST_COMPRESSION); |
| 2861 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a45f47c | 2011-04-01 15:31:26 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2862 | /* Set other zlib parameters for compressing IDAT */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2863 | png_set_compression_mem_level(png_ptr, 8); |
| 2864 | png_set_compression_strategy(png_ptr, |
| 2865 | Z_DEFAULT_STRATEGY); |
| 2866 | png_set_compression_window_bits(png_ptr, 15); |
| 2867 | png_set_compression_method(png_ptr, 8); |
| 2868 | png_set_compression_buffer_size(png_ptr, 8192) |
| 2869 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a45f47c | 2011-04-01 15:31:26 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2870 | /* Set zlib parameters for text compression |
| 2871 | * If you don't call these, the parameters |
| 2872 | * fall back on those defined for IDAT chunks |
| 2873 | */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8eb8833 | 2011-04-01 00:16:50 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2874 | png_set_text_compression_mem_level(png_ptr, 8); |
| 2875 | png_set_text_compression_strategy(png_ptr, |
| 2876 | Z_DEFAULT_STRATEGY); |
| 2877 | png_set_text_compression_window_bits(png_ptr, 15); |
| 2878 | png_set_text_compression_method(png_ptr, 8); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2879 | |
| 2880 | Setting the contents of info for output |
| 2881 | |
| 2882 | You now need to fill in the png_info structure with all the data you |
| 2883 | wish to write before the actual image. Note that the only thing you |
| 2884 | are allowed to write after the image is the text chunks and the time |
| 2885 | chunk (as of PNG Specification 1.2, anyway). See png_write_end() and |
| 2886 | the latest PNG specification for more information on that. If you |
| 2887 | wish to write them before the image, fill them in now, and flag that |
| 2888 | data as being valid. If you want to wait until after the data, don't |
| 2889 | fill them until png_write_end(). For all the fields in png_info and |
| 2890 | their data types, see png.h. For explanations of what the fields |
| 2891 | contain, see the PNG specification. |
| 2892 | |
| 2893 | Some of the more important parts of the png_info are: |
| 2894 | |
| 2895 | png_set_IHDR(png_ptr, info_ptr, width, height, |
| 2896 | bit_depth, color_type, interlace_type, |
| 2897 | compression_type, filter_method) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2898 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2899 | width - holds the width of the image |
| 2900 | in pixels (up to 2^31). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2901 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2902 | height - holds the height of the image |
| 2903 | in pixels (up to 2^31). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2904 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2905 | bit_depth - holds the bit depth of one of the |
| 2906 | image channels. |
| 2907 | (valid values are 1, 2, 4, 8, 16 |
| 2908 | and depend also on the |
| 2909 | color_type. See also significant |
| 2910 | bits (sBIT) below). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2911 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2912 | color_type - describes which color/alpha |
| 2913 | channels are present. |
| 2914 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY |
| 2915 | (bit depths 1, 2, 4, 8, 16) |
| 2916 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA |
| 2917 | (bit depths 8, 16) |
| 2918 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE |
| 2919 | (bit depths 1, 2, 4, 8) |
| 2920 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB |
| 2921 | (bit_depths 8, 16) |
| 2922 | PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA |
| 2923 | (bit_depths 8, 16) |
| 2924 | |
| 2925 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_PALETTE |
| 2926 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR |
| 2927 | PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA |
| 2928 | |
| 2929 | interlace_type - PNG_INTERLACE_NONE or |
| 2930 | PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2931 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2932 | compression_type - (must be |
| 2933 | PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_DEFAULT) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2934 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2935 | filter_method - (must be PNG_FILTER_TYPE_DEFAULT |
| 2936 | or, if you are writing a PNG to |
| 2937 | be embedded in a MNG datastream, |
| 2938 | can also be |
| 2939 | PNG_INTRAPIXEL_DIFFERENCING) |
| 2940 | |
| 2941 | If you call png_set_IHDR(), the call must appear before any of the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d60c886 | 2009-06-15 21:56:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2942 | other png_set_*() functions, because they might require access to some of |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2943 | the IHDR settings. The remaining png_set_*() functions can be called |
| 2944 | in any order. |
| 2945 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9dcde09 | 2009-06-08 08:31:59 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2946 | If you wish, you can reset the compression_type, interlace_type, or |
| 2947 | filter_method later by calling png_set_IHDR() again; if you do this, the |
| 2948 | width, height, bit_depth, and color_type must be the same in each call. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 37e7e0b | 2009-06-02 13:46:41 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2949 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2950 | png_set_PLTE(png_ptr, info_ptr, palette, |
| 2951 | num_palette); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2952 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2953 | palette - the palette for the file |
| 2954 | (array of png_color) |
| 2955 | num_palette - number of entries in the palette |
| 2956 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2957 | png_set_gAMA(png_ptr, info_ptr, file_gamma); |
| 2958 | png_set_gAMA_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, int_file_gamma); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2959 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2960 | file_gamma - the gamma at which the image was |
| 2961 | created (PNG_INFO_gAMA) |
| 2962 | |
| 2963 | int_file_gamma - 100,000 times the gamma at which |
| 2964 | the image was created |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2965 | |
John Bowler | bbd17bd | 2011-08-25 17:48:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2966 | png_set_cHRM(png_ptr, info_ptr, white_x, white_y, red_x, red_y, |
| 2967 | green_x, green_y, blue_x, blue_y) |
| 2968 | png_set_cHRM_XYZ(png_ptr, info_ptr, red_X, red_Y, red_Z, green_X, |
| 2969 | green_Y, green_Z, blue_X, blue_Y, blue_Z) |
| 2970 | png_set_cHRM_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, int_white_x, int_white_y, |
| 2971 | int_red_x, int_red_y, int_green_x, int_green_y, |
| 2972 | int_blue_x, int_blue_y) |
| 2973 | png_set_cHRM_XYZ_fixed(png_ptr, info_ptr, int_red_X, int_red_Y, |
| 2974 | int_red_Z, int_green_X, int_green_Y, int_green_Z, |
| 2975 | int_blue_X, int_blue_Y, int_blue_Z) |
| 2976 | |
| 2977 | {white,red,green,blue}_{x,y} |
| 2978 | A color space encoding specified using the chromaticities |
| 2979 | of the end points and the white point. |
| 2980 | |
| 2981 | {red,green,blue}_{X,Y,Z} |
| 2982 | A color space encoding specified using the encoding end |
| 2983 | points - the CIE tristimulus specification of the intended |
| 2984 | color of the red, green and blue channels in the PNG RGB |
| 2985 | data. The white point is simply the sum of the three end |
| 2986 | points. |
| 2987 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2988 | png_set_sRGB(png_ptr, info_ptr, srgb_intent); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 2989 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2990 | srgb_intent - the rendering intent |
| 2991 | (PNG_INFO_sRGB) The presence of |
| 2992 | the sRGB chunk means that the pixel |
| 2993 | data is in the sRGB color space. |
| 2994 | This chunk also implies specific |
| 2995 | values of gAMA and cHRM. Rendering |
| 2996 | intent is the CSS-1 property that |
| 2997 | has been defined by the International |
| 2998 | Color Consortium |
| 2999 | (http://www.color.org). |
| 3000 | It can be one of |
| 3001 | PNG_sRGB_INTENT_SATURATION, |
| 3002 | PNG_sRGB_INTENT_PERCEPTUAL, |
| 3003 | PNG_sRGB_INTENT_ABSOLUTE, or |
| 3004 | PNG_sRGB_INTENT_RELATIVE. |
| 3005 | |
| 3006 | |
| 3007 | png_set_sRGB_gAMA_and_cHRM(png_ptr, info_ptr, |
| 3008 | srgb_intent); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3009 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3010 | srgb_intent - the rendering intent |
| 3011 | (PNG_INFO_sRGB) The presence of the |
| 3012 | sRGB chunk means that the pixel |
| 3013 | data is in the sRGB color space. |
| 3014 | This function also causes gAMA and |
| 3015 | cHRM chunks with the specific values |
| 3016 | that are consistent with sRGB to be |
| 3017 | written. |
| 3018 | |
| 3019 | png_set_iCCP(png_ptr, info_ptr, name, compression_type, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3020 | profile, proflen); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3021 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3022 | name - The profile name. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3023 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3024 | compression_type - The compression type; always |
| 3025 | PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE for PNG 1.0. |
| 3026 | You may give NULL to this argument to |
| 3027 | ignore it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3028 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3029 | profile - International Color Consortium color |
| 3030 | profile data. May contain NULs. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3031 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4a5a1ec | 2011-01-15 11:43:28 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3032 | proflen - length of profile data in bytes. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3033 | |
| 3034 | png_set_sBIT(png_ptr, info_ptr, sig_bit); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3035 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3036 | sig_bit - the number of significant bits for |
| 3037 | (PNG_INFO_sBIT) each of the gray, red, |
| 3038 | green, and blue channels, whichever are |
| 3039 | appropriate for the given color type |
| 3040 | (png_color_16) |
| 3041 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 866b62a | 2009-08-08 16:33:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3042 | png_set_tRNS(png_ptr, info_ptr, trans_alpha, |
| 3043 | num_trans, trans_color); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3044 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 866b62a | 2009-08-08 16:33:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3045 | trans_alpha - array of alpha (transparency) |
| 3046 | entries for palette (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3047 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3048 | num_trans - number of transparent entries |
| 3049 | (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
| 3050 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9dcde09 | 2009-06-08 08:31:59 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3051 | trans_color - graylevel or color sample values |
| 3052 | (in order red, green, blue) of the |
| 3053 | single transparent color for |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3054 | non-paletted images (PNG_INFO_tRNS) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3055 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3056 | png_set_hIST(png_ptr, info_ptr, hist); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3057 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3058 | hist - histogram of palette (array of |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8d0bc0f | 2011-01-25 22:15:58 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3059 | png_uint_16) (PNG_INFO_hIST) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3060 | |
| 3061 | png_set_tIME(png_ptr, info_ptr, mod_time); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3062 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3063 | mod_time - time image was last modified |
| 3064 | (PNG_VALID_tIME) |
| 3065 | |
| 3066 | png_set_bKGD(png_ptr, info_ptr, background); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3067 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ab38979 | 2011-07-09 19:35:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3068 | background - background color (of type |
| 3069 | png_color_16p) (PNG_VALID_bKGD) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3070 | |
| 3071 | png_set_text(png_ptr, info_ptr, text_ptr, num_text); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3072 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3073 | text_ptr - array of png_text holding image |
| 3074 | comments |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3075 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3076 | text_ptr[i].compression - type of compression used |
| 3077 | on "text" PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE |
| 3078 | PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt |
| 3079 | PNG_ITXT_COMPRESSION_NONE |
| 3080 | PNG_ITXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt |
| 3081 | text_ptr[i].key - keyword for comment. Must contain |
| 3082 | 1-79 characters. |
| 3083 | text_ptr[i].text - text comments for current |
| 3084 | keyword. Can be NULL or empty. |
| 3085 | text_ptr[i].text_length - length of text string, |
| 3086 | after decompression, 0 for iTXt |
| 3087 | text_ptr[i].itxt_length - length of itxt string, |
| 3088 | after decompression, 0 for tEXt/zTXt |
| 3089 | text_ptr[i].lang - language of comment (NULL or |
| 3090 | empty for unknown). |
| 3091 | text_ptr[i].translated_keyword - keyword in UTF-8 (NULL |
| 3092 | or empty for unknown). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 680da02 | 2011-11-21 17:05:41 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3093 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ef29a5e | 2009-10-31 19:37:05 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3094 | Note that the itxt_length, lang, and lang_key |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 680da02 | 2011-11-21 17:05:41 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3095 | members of the text_ptr structure only exist when the |
| 3096 | library is built with iTXt chunk support. Prior to |
| 3097 | libpng-1.4.0 the library was built by default without |
| 3098 | iTXt support. Also note that when iTXt is supported, |
| 3099 | they contain NULL pointers when the "compression" |
| 3100 | field contains PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE or |
| 3101 | PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ef29a5e | 2009-10-31 19:37:05 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3102 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3103 | num_text - number of comments |
| 3104 | |
| 3105 | png_set_sPLT(png_ptr, info_ptr, &palette_ptr, |
| 3106 | num_spalettes); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3107 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3108 | palette_ptr - array of png_sPLT_struct structures |
| 3109 | to be added to the list of palettes |
| 3110 | in the info structure. |
| 3111 | num_spalettes - number of palette structures to be |
| 3112 | added. |
| 3113 | |
| 3114 | png_set_oFFs(png_ptr, info_ptr, offset_x, offset_y, |
| 3115 | unit_type); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3116 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3117 | offset_x - positive offset from the left |
| 3118 | edge of the screen |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3119 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3120 | offset_y - positive offset from the top |
| 3121 | edge of the screen |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3122 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3123 | unit_type - PNG_OFFSET_PIXEL, PNG_OFFSET_MICROMETER |
| 3124 | |
| 3125 | png_set_pHYs(png_ptr, info_ptr, res_x, res_y, |
| 3126 | unit_type); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3127 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3128 | res_x - pixels/unit physical resolution |
| 3129 | in x direction |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3130 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3131 | res_y - pixels/unit physical resolution |
| 3132 | in y direction |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3133 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3134 | unit_type - PNG_RESOLUTION_UNKNOWN, |
| 3135 | PNG_RESOLUTION_METER |
| 3136 | |
| 3137 | png_set_sCAL(png_ptr, info_ptr, unit, width, height) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3138 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3139 | unit - physical scale units (an integer) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3140 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3141 | width - width of a pixel in physical scale units |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3142 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3143 | height - height of a pixel in physical scale units |
| 3144 | (width and height are doubles) |
| 3145 | |
| 3146 | png_set_sCAL_s(png_ptr, info_ptr, unit, width, height) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3147 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3148 | unit - physical scale units (an integer) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3149 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3150 | width - width of a pixel in physical scale units |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3151 | expressed as a string |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3152 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3153 | height - height of a pixel in physical scale units |
| 3154 | (width and height are strings like "2.54") |
| 3155 | |
| 3156 | png_set_unknown_chunks(png_ptr, info_ptr, &unknowns, |
| 3157 | num_unknowns) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3158 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3159 | unknowns - array of png_unknown_chunk |
| 3160 | structures holding unknown chunks |
| 3161 | unknowns[i].name - name of unknown chunk |
| 3162 | unknowns[i].data - data of unknown chunk |
| 3163 | unknowns[i].size - size of unknown chunk's data |
| 3164 | unknowns[i].location - position to write chunk in file |
| 3165 | 0: do not write chunk |
| 3166 | PNG_HAVE_IHDR: before PLTE |
| 3167 | PNG_HAVE_PLTE: before IDAT |
| 3168 | PNG_AFTER_IDAT: after IDAT |
| 3169 | |
| 3170 | The "location" member is set automatically according to |
| 3171 | what part of the output file has already been written. |
| 3172 | You can change its value after calling png_set_unknown_chunks() |
| 3173 | as demonstrated in pngtest.c. Within each of the "locations", |
| 3174 | the chunks are sequenced according to their position in the |
| 3175 | structure (that is, the value of "i", which is the order in which |
| 3176 | the chunk was either read from the input file or defined with |
| 3177 | png_set_unknown_chunks). |
| 3178 | |
| 3179 | A quick word about text and num_text. text is an array of png_text |
| 3180 | structures. num_text is the number of valid structures in the array. |
| 3181 | Each png_text structure holds a language code, a keyword, a text value, |
| 3182 | and a compression type. |
| 3183 | |
| 3184 | The compression types have the same valid numbers as the compression |
| 3185 | types of the image data. Currently, the only valid number is zero. |
| 3186 | However, you can store text either compressed or uncompressed, unlike |
| 3187 | images, which always have to be compressed. So if you don't want the |
| 3188 | text compressed, set the compression type to PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE. |
| 3189 | Because tEXt and zTXt chunks don't have a language field, if you |
| 3190 | specify PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE or PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt |
| 3191 | any language code or translated keyword will not be written out. |
| 3192 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3193 | Until text gets around a few hundred bytes, it is not worth compressing it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3194 | After the text has been written out to the file, the compression type |
| 3195 | is set to PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE_WR or PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt_WR, |
| 3196 | so that it isn't written out again at the end (in case you are calling |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3197 | png_write_end() with the same struct). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3198 | |
| 3199 | The keywords that are given in the PNG Specification are: |
| 3200 | |
| 3201 | Title Short (one line) title or |
| 3202 | caption for image |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3203 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3204 | Author Name of image's creator |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3205 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3206 | Description Description of image (possibly long) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3207 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3208 | Copyright Copyright notice |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3209 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3210 | Creation Time Time of original image creation |
| 3211 | (usually RFC 1123 format, see below) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3212 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3213 | Software Software used to create the image |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3214 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3215 | Disclaimer Legal disclaimer |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3216 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3217 | Warning Warning of nature of content |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3218 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3219 | Source Device used to create the image |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3220 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3221 | Comment Miscellaneous comment; conversion |
| 3222 | from other image format |
| 3223 | |
| 3224 | The keyword-text pairs work like this. Keywords should be short |
| 3225 | simple descriptions of what the comment is about. Some typical |
| 3226 | keywords are found in the PNG specification, as is some recommendations |
| 3227 | on keywords. You can repeat keywords in a file. You can even write |
| 3228 | some text before the image and some after. For example, you may want |
| 3229 | to put a description of the image before the image, but leave the |
| 3230 | disclaimer until after, so viewers working over modem connections |
| 3231 | don't have to wait for the disclaimer to go over the modem before |
| 3232 | they start seeing the image. Finally, keywords should be full |
| 3233 | words, not abbreviations. Keywords and text are in the ISO 8859-1 |
| 3234 | (Latin-1) character set (a superset of regular ASCII) and can not |
| 3235 | contain NUL characters, and should not contain control or other |
| 3236 | unprintable characters. To make the comments widely readable, stick |
| 3237 | with basic ASCII, and avoid machine specific character set extensions |
| 3238 | like the IBM-PC character set. The keyword must be present, but |
| 3239 | you can leave off the text string on non-compressed pairs. |
| 3240 | Compressed pairs must have a text string, as only the text string |
| 3241 | is compressed anyway, so the compression would be meaningless. |
| 3242 | |
| 3243 | PNG supports modification time via the png_time structure. Two |
| 3244 | conversion routines are provided, png_convert_from_time_t() for |
| 3245 | time_t and png_convert_from_struct_tm() for struct tm. The |
| 3246 | time_t routine uses gmtime(). You don't have to use either of |
| 3247 | these, but if you wish to fill in the png_time structure directly, |
| 3248 | you should provide the time in universal time (GMT) if possible |
| 3249 | instead of your local time. Note that the year number is the full |
| 3250 | year (e.g. 1998, rather than 98 - PNG is year 2000 compliant!), and |
| 3251 | that months start with 1. |
| 3252 | |
| 3253 | If you want to store the time of the original image creation, you should |
| 3254 | use a plain tEXt chunk with the "Creation Time" keyword. This is |
| 3255 | necessary because the "creation time" of a PNG image is somewhat vague, |
| 3256 | depending on whether you mean the PNG file, the time the image was |
| 3257 | created in a non-PNG format, a still photo from which the image was |
| 3258 | scanned, or possibly the subject matter itself. In order to facilitate |
| 3259 | machine-readable dates, it is recommended that the "Creation Time" |
| 3260 | tEXt chunk use RFC 1123 format dates (e.g. "22 May 1997 18:07:10 GMT"), |
| 3261 | although this isn't a requirement. Unlike the tIME chunk, the |
| 3262 | "Creation Time" tEXt chunk is not expected to be automatically changed |
| 3263 | by the software. To facilitate the use of RFC 1123 dates, a function |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3264 | png_convert_to_rfc1123_buffer(png_ptr, buffer, png_timep) is provided to |
| 3265 | convert from PNG time to an RFC 1123 format string. The caller must provide |
| 3266 | a writeable buffer of at least 29 bytes. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3267 | |
| 3268 | Writing unknown chunks |
| 3269 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3270 | You can use the png_set_unknown_chunks function to queue up private chunks |
| 3271 | for writing. You give it a chunk name, location, raw data, and a size. You |
| 3272 | also must use png_set_keep_unknown_chunks() to ensure that libpng will |
| 3273 | handle them. That's all there is to it. The chunks will be written by the |
| 3274 | next following png_write_info_before_PLTE, png_write_info, or png_write_end |
| 3275 | function, depending upon the specified location. Any chunks previously |
| 3276 | read into the info structure's unknown-chunk list will also be written out |
| 3277 | in a sequence that satisfies the PNG specification's ordering rules. |
| 3278 | |
| 3279 | Here is an example of writing two private chunks, prVt and miNE: |
| 3280 | |
| 3281 | #ifdef PNG_WRITE_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED |
| 3282 | /* Set unknown chunk data */ |
| 3283 | png_unknown_chunk unk_chunk[2]; |
| 3284 | strcpy((char *) unk_chunk[0].name, "prVt"; |
| 3285 | unk_chunk[0].data = (unsigned char *) "PRIVATE DATA"; |
| 3286 | unk_chunk[0].size = strlen(unk_chunk[0].data)+1; |
| 3287 | unk_chunk[0].location = PNG_HAVE_IHDR; |
| 3288 | strcpy((char *) unk_chunk[1].name, "miNE"; |
| 3289 | unk_chunk[1].data = (unsigned char *) "MY CHUNK DATA"; |
| 3290 | unk_chunk[1].size = strlen(unk_chunk[0].data)+1; |
| 3291 | unk_chunk[1].location = PNG_AFTER_IDAT; |
| 3292 | png_set_unknown_chunks(write_ptr, write_info_ptr, |
| 3293 | unk_chunk, 2); |
| 3294 | /* Needed because miNE is not safe-to-copy */ |
| 3295 | png_set_keep_unknown_chunks(png, PNG_HANDLE_CHUNK_ALWAYS, |
| 3296 | (png_bytep) "miNE", 1); |
| 3297 | # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10600 |
| 3298 | /* Deal with unknown chunk location bug in 1.5.x and earlier */ |
| 3299 | png_set_unknown_chunk_location(png, info, 0, PNG_HAVE_IHDR); |
| 3300 | png_set_unknown_chunk_location(png, info, 1, PNG_AFTER_IDAT); |
| 3301 | # endif |
| 3302 | # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500 |
| 3303 | /* PNG_AFTER_IDAT writes two copies of the chunk prior to libpng-1.5.0, |
| 3304 | * one before IDAT and another after IDAT, so don't use it; only use |
| 3305 | * PNG_HAVE_IHDR location. This call resets the location previously |
| 3306 | * set by assignment and png_set_unknown_chunk_location() for chunk 1. |
| 3307 | */ |
| 3308 | png_set_unknown_chunk_location(png, info, 1, PNG_HAVE_IHDR); |
| 3309 | # endif |
| 3310 | #endif |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3311 | |
| 3312 | The high-level write interface |
| 3313 | |
| 3314 | At this point there are two ways to proceed; through the high-level |
| 3315 | write interface, or through a sequence of low-level write operations. |
| 3316 | You can use the high-level interface if your image data is present |
| 3317 | in the info structure. All defined output |
| 3318 | transformations are permitted, enabled by the following masks. |
| 3319 | |
| 3320 | PNG_TRANSFORM_IDENTITY No transformation |
| 3321 | PNG_TRANSFORM_PACKING Pack 1, 2 and 4-bit samples |
| 3322 | PNG_TRANSFORM_PACKSWAP Change order of packed |
| 3323 | pixels to LSB first |
| 3324 | PNG_TRANSFORM_INVERT_MONO Invert monochrome images |
| 3325 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SHIFT Normalize pixels to the |
| 3326 | sBIT depth |
| 3327 | PNG_TRANSFORM_BGR Flip RGB to BGR, RGBA |
| 3328 | to BGRA |
| 3329 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SWAP_ALPHA Flip RGBA to ARGB or GA |
| 3330 | to AG |
| 3331 | PNG_TRANSFORM_INVERT_ALPHA Change alpha from opacity |
| 3332 | to transparency |
| 3333 | PNG_TRANSFORM_SWAP_ENDIAN Byte-swap 16-bit samples |
| 3334 | PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_FILLER Strip out filler |
| 3335 | bytes (deprecated). |
| 3336 | PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_FILLER_BEFORE Strip out leading |
| 3337 | filler bytes |
| 3338 | PNG_TRANSFORM_STRIP_FILLER_AFTER Strip out trailing |
| 3339 | filler bytes |
| 3340 | |
| 3341 | If you have valid image data in the info structure (you can use |
| 3342 | png_set_rows() to put image data in the info structure), simply do this: |
| 3343 | |
| 3344 | png_write_png(png_ptr, info_ptr, png_transforms, NULL) |
| 3345 | |
| 3346 | where png_transforms is an integer containing the bitwise OR of some set of |
| 3347 | transformation flags. This call is equivalent to png_write_info(), |
| 3348 | followed the set of transformations indicated by the transform mask, |
| 3349 | then png_write_image(), and finally png_write_end(). |
| 3350 | |
| 3351 | (The final parameter of this call is not yet used. Someday it might point |
| 3352 | to transformation parameters required by some future output transform.) |
| 3353 | |
| 3354 | You must use png_transforms and not call any png_set_transform() functions |
| 3355 | when you use png_write_png(). |
| 3356 | |
| 3357 | The low-level write interface |
| 3358 | |
| 3359 | If you are going the low-level route instead, you are now ready to |
| 3360 | write all the file information up to the actual image data. You do |
| 3361 | this with a call to png_write_info(). |
| 3362 | |
| 3363 | png_write_info(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 3364 | |
| 3365 | Note that there is one transformation you may need to do before |
| 3366 | png_write_info(). In PNG files, the alpha channel in an image is the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3367 | level of opacity. If your data is supplied as a level of transparency, |
| 3368 | you can invert the alpha channel before you write it, so that 0 is |
| 3369 | fully transparent and 255 (in 8-bit or paletted images) or 65535 |
| 3370 | (in 16-bit images) is fully opaque, with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3371 | |
| 3372 | png_set_invert_alpha(png_ptr); |
| 3373 | |
| 3374 | This must appear before png_write_info() instead of later with the |
| 3375 | other transformations because in the case of paletted images the tRNS |
| 3376 | chunk data has to be inverted before the tRNS chunk is written. If |
| 3377 | your image is not a paletted image, the tRNS data (which in such cases |
| 3378 | represents a single color to be rendered as transparent) won't need to |
| 3379 | be changed, and you can safely do this transformation after your |
| 3380 | png_write_info() call. |
| 3381 | |
| 3382 | If you need to write a private chunk that you want to appear before |
| 3383 | the PLTE chunk when PLTE is present, you can write the PNG info in |
| 3384 | two steps, and insert code to write your own chunk between them: |
| 3385 | |
| 3386 | png_write_info_before_PLTE(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 3387 | png_set_unknown_chunks(png_ptr, info_ptr, ...); |
| 3388 | png_write_info(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 3389 | |
| 3390 | After you've written the file information, you can set up the library |
| 3391 | to handle any special transformations of the image data. The various |
| 3392 | ways to transform the data will be described in the order that they |
| 3393 | should occur. This is important, as some of these change the color |
| 3394 | type and/or bit depth of the data, and some others only work on |
| 3395 | certain color types and bit depths. Even though each transformation |
| 3396 | checks to see if it has data that it can do something with, you should |
| 3397 | make sure to only enable a transformation if it will be valid for the |
| 3398 | data. For example, don't swap red and blue on grayscale data. |
| 3399 | |
| 3400 | PNG files store RGB pixels packed into 3 or 6 bytes. This code tells |
| 3401 | the library to strip input data that has 4 or 8 bytes per pixel down |
| 3402 | to 3 or 6 bytes (or strip 2 or 4-byte grayscale+filler data to 1 or 2 |
| 3403 | bytes per pixel). |
| 3404 | |
| 3405 | png_set_filler(png_ptr, 0, PNG_FILLER_BEFORE); |
| 3406 | |
| 3407 | where the 0 is unused, and the location is either PNG_FILLER_BEFORE or |
| 3408 | PNG_FILLER_AFTER, depending upon whether the filler byte in the pixel |
| 3409 | is stored XRGB or RGBX. |
| 3410 | |
| 3411 | PNG files pack pixels of bit depths 1, 2, and 4 into bytes as small as |
| 3412 | they can, resulting in, for example, 8 pixels per byte for 1 bit files. |
| 3413 | If the data is supplied at 1 pixel per byte, use this code, which will |
| 3414 | correctly pack the pixels into a single byte: |
| 3415 | |
| 3416 | png_set_packing(png_ptr); |
| 3417 | |
| 3418 | PNG files reduce possible bit depths to 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16. If your |
| 3419 | data is of another bit depth, you can write an sBIT chunk into the |
| 3420 | file so that decoders can recover the original data if desired. |
| 3421 | |
| 3422 | /* Set the true bit depth of the image data */ |
| 3423 | if (color_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) |
| 3424 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3425 | sig_bit.red = true_bit_depth; |
| 3426 | sig_bit.green = true_bit_depth; |
| 3427 | sig_bit.blue = true_bit_depth; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3428 | } |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3429 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3430 | else |
| 3431 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3432 | sig_bit.gray = true_bit_depth; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3433 | } |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3434 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3435 | if (color_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) |
| 3436 | { |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3437 | sig_bit.alpha = true_bit_depth; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3438 | } |
| 3439 | |
| 3440 | png_set_sBIT(png_ptr, info_ptr, &sig_bit); |
| 3441 | |
| 3442 | If the data is stored in the row buffer in a bit depth other than |
| 3443 | one supported by PNG (e.g. 3 bit data in the range 0-7 for a 4-bit PNG), |
| 3444 | this will scale the values to appear to be the correct bit depth as |
| 3445 | is required by PNG. |
| 3446 | |
| 3447 | png_set_shift(png_ptr, &sig_bit); |
| 3448 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 593fc04 | 2011-05-12 22:18:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3449 | PNG files store 16-bit pixels in network byte order (big-endian, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3450 | ie. most significant bits first). This code would be used if they are |
| 3451 | supplied the other way (little-endian, i.e. least significant bits |
| 3452 | first, the way PCs store them): |
| 3453 | |
| 3454 | if (bit_depth > 8) |
| 3455 | png_set_swap(png_ptr); |
| 3456 | |
| 3457 | If you are using packed-pixel images (1, 2, or 4 bits/pixel), and you |
| 3458 | need to change the order the pixels are packed into bytes, you can use: |
| 3459 | |
| 3460 | if (bit_depth < 8) |
| 3461 | png_set_packswap(png_ptr); |
| 3462 | |
| 3463 | PNG files store 3 color pixels in red, green, blue order. This code |
| 3464 | would be used if they are supplied as blue, green, red: |
| 3465 | |
| 3466 | png_set_bgr(png_ptr); |
| 3467 | |
| 3468 | PNG files describe monochrome as black being zero and white being |
| 3469 | one. This code would be used if the pixels are supplied with this reversed |
| 3470 | (black being one and white being zero): |
| 3471 | |
| 3472 | png_set_invert_mono(png_ptr); |
| 3473 | |
| 3474 | Finally, you can write your own transformation function if none of |
| 3475 | the existing ones meets your needs. This is done by setting a callback |
| 3476 | with |
| 3477 | |
| 3478 | png_set_write_user_transform_fn(png_ptr, |
| 3479 | write_transform_fn); |
| 3480 | |
| 3481 | You must supply the function |
| 3482 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9321567 | 2011-02-13 19:42:19 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3483 | void write_transform_fn(png_structp png_ptr, png_row_infop |
| 3484 | row_info, png_bytep data) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3485 | |
| 3486 | See pngtest.c for a working example. Your function will be called |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3487 | before any of the other transformations are processed. If supported |
| 3488 | libpng also supplies an information routine that may be called from |
| 3489 | your callback: |
| 3490 | |
| 3491 | png_get_current_row_number(png_ptr); |
John Bowler | cd11345 | 2011-02-16 06:15:13 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3492 | png_get_current_pass_number(png_ptr); |
John Bowler | 0a5c9c0 | 2011-01-22 17:36:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3493 | |
John Bowler | cd11345 | 2011-02-16 06:15:13 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3494 | This returns the current row passed to the transform. With interlaced |
| 3495 | images the value returned is the row in the input sub-image image. Use |
| 3496 | PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(row, pass) and PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(col, pass) to |
| 3497 | find the output pixel (x,y) given an interlaced sub-image pixel (row,col,pass). |
| 3498 | |
| 3499 | The discussion of interlace handling above contains more information on how to |
| 3500 | use these values. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3501 | |
| 3502 | You can also set up a pointer to a user structure for use by your |
| 3503 | callback function. |
| 3504 | |
| 3505 | png_set_user_transform_info(png_ptr, user_ptr, 0, 0); |
| 3506 | |
| 3507 | The user_channels and user_depth parameters of this function are ignored |
| 3508 | when writing; you can set them to zero as shown. |
| 3509 | |
| 3510 | You can retrieve the pointer via the function png_get_user_transform_ptr(). |
| 3511 | For example: |
| 3512 | |
| 3513 | voidp write_user_transform_ptr = |
| 3514 | png_get_user_transform_ptr(png_ptr); |
| 3515 | |
| 3516 | It is possible to have libpng flush any pending output, either manually, |
| 3517 | or automatically after a certain number of lines have been written. To |
| 3518 | flush the output stream a single time call: |
| 3519 | |
| 3520 | png_write_flush(png_ptr); |
| 3521 | |
| 3522 | and to have libpng flush the output stream periodically after a certain |
| 3523 | number of scanlines have been written, call: |
| 3524 | |
| 3525 | png_set_flush(png_ptr, nrows); |
| 3526 | |
| 3527 | Note that the distance between rows is from the last time png_write_flush() |
| 3528 | was called, or the first row of the image if it has never been called. |
| 3529 | So if you write 50 lines, and then png_set_flush 25, it will flush the |
| 3530 | output on the next scanline, and every 25 lines thereafter, unless |
| 3531 | png_write_flush() is called before 25 more lines have been written. |
| 3532 | If nrows is too small (less than about 10 lines for a 640 pixel wide |
| 3533 | RGB image) the image compression may decrease noticeably (although this |
| 3534 | may be acceptable for real-time applications). Infrequent flushing will |
| 3535 | only degrade the compression performance by a few percent over images |
| 3536 | that do not use flushing. |
| 3537 | |
| 3538 | Writing the image data |
| 3539 | |
| 3540 | That's it for the transformations. Now you can write the image data. |
| 3541 | The simplest way to do this is in one function call. If you have the |
| 3542 | whole image in memory, you can just call png_write_image() and libpng |
| 3543 | will write the image. You will need to pass in an array of pointers to |
| 3544 | each row. This function automatically handles interlacing, so you don't |
| 3545 | need to call png_set_interlace_handling() or call this function multiple |
| 3546 | times, or any of that other stuff necessary with png_write_rows(). |
| 3547 | |
| 3548 | png_write_image(png_ptr, row_pointers); |
| 3549 | |
| 3550 | where row_pointers is: |
| 3551 | |
| 3552 | png_byte *row_pointers[height]; |
| 3553 | |
| 3554 | You can point to void or char or whatever you use for pixels. |
| 3555 | |
| 3556 | If you don't want to write the whole image at once, you can |
| 3557 | use png_write_rows() instead. If the file is not interlaced, |
| 3558 | this is simple: |
| 3559 | |
| 3560 | png_write_rows(png_ptr, row_pointers, |
| 3561 | number_of_rows); |
| 3562 | |
| 3563 | row_pointers is the same as in the png_write_image() call. |
| 3564 | |
| 3565 | If you are just writing one row at a time, you can do this with |
| 3566 | a single row_pointer instead of an array of row_pointers: |
| 3567 | |
| 3568 | png_bytep row_pointer = row; |
| 3569 | |
| 3570 | png_write_row(png_ptr, row_pointer); |
| 3571 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3572 | When the file is interlaced, things can get a good deal more complicated. |
| 3573 | The only currently (as of the PNG Specification version 1.2, dated July |
| 3574 | 1999) defined interlacing scheme for PNG files is the "Adam7" interlace |
| 3575 | scheme, that breaks down an image into seven smaller images of varying |
| 3576 | size. libpng will build these images for you, or you can do them |
| 3577 | yourself. If you want to build them yourself, see the PNG specification |
| 3578 | for details of which pixels to write when. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3579 | |
| 3580 | If you don't want libpng to handle the interlacing details, just |
| 3581 | use png_set_interlace_handling() and call png_write_rows() the |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3582 | correct number of times to write all the sub-images |
| 3583 | (png_set_interlace_handling() returns the number of sub-images.) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3584 | |
| 3585 | If you want libpng to build the sub-images, call this before you start |
| 3586 | writing any rows: |
| 3587 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3588 | number_of_passes = png_set_interlace_handling(png_ptr); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3589 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3590 | This will return the number of passes needed. Currently, this is seven, |
| 3591 | but may change if another interlace type is added. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3592 | |
| 3593 | Then write the complete image number_of_passes times. |
| 3594 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3595 | png_write_rows(png_ptr, row_pointers, number_of_rows); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3596 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3597 | Think carefully before you write an interlaced image. Typically code that |
| 3598 | reads such images reads all the image data into memory, uncompressed, before |
| 3599 | doing any processing. Only code that can display an image on the fly can |
| 3600 | take advantage of the interlacing and even then the image has to be exactly |
| 3601 | the correct size for the output device, because scaling an image requires |
| 3602 | adjacent pixels and these are not available until all the passes have been |
| 3603 | read. |
| 3604 | |
| 3605 | If you do write an interlaced image you will hardly ever need to handle |
| 3606 | the interlacing yourself. Call png_set_interlace_handling() and use the |
| 3607 | approach described above. |
| 3608 | |
| 3609 | The only time it is conceivable that you will really need to write an |
| 3610 | interlaced image pass-by-pass is when you have read one pass by pass and |
| 3611 | made some pixel-by-pixel transformation to it, as described in the read |
| 3612 | code above. In this case use the PNG_PASS_ROWS and PNG_PASS_COLS macros |
| 3613 | to determine the size of each sub-image in turn and simply write the rows |
| 3614 | you obtained from the read code. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3615 | |
| 3616 | Finishing a sequential write |
| 3617 | |
| 3618 | After you are finished writing the image, you should finish writing |
| 3619 | the file. If you are interested in writing comments or time, you should |
| 3620 | pass an appropriately filled png_info pointer. If you are not interested, |
| 3621 | you can pass NULL. |
| 3622 | |
| 3623 | png_write_end(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 3624 | |
| 3625 | When you are done, you can free all memory used by libpng like this: |
| 3626 | |
| 3627 | png_destroy_write_struct(&png_ptr, &info_ptr); |
| 3628 | |
| 3629 | It is also possible to individually free the info_ptr members that |
| 3630 | point to libpng-allocated storage with the following function: |
| 3631 | |
| 3632 | png_free_data(png_ptr, info_ptr, mask, seq) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3633 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3634 | mask - identifies data to be freed, a mask |
| 3635 | containing the bitwise OR of one or |
| 3636 | more of |
| 3637 | PNG_FREE_PLTE, PNG_FREE_TRNS, |
| 3638 | PNG_FREE_HIST, PNG_FREE_ICCP, |
| 3639 | PNG_FREE_PCAL, PNG_FREE_ROWS, |
| 3640 | PNG_FREE_SCAL, PNG_FREE_SPLT, |
| 3641 | PNG_FREE_TEXT, PNG_FREE_UNKN, |
| 3642 | or simply PNG_FREE_ALL |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3643 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3644 | seq - sequence number of item to be freed |
| 3645 | (-1 for all items) |
| 3646 | |
| 3647 | This function may be safely called when the relevant storage has |
| 3648 | already been freed, or has not yet been allocated, or was allocated |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3649 | by the user and not by libpng, and will in those cases do nothing. |
| 3650 | The "seq" parameter is ignored if only one item of the selected data |
| 3651 | type, such as PLTE, is allowed. If "seq" is not -1, and multiple items |
| 3652 | are allowed for the data type identified in the mask, such as text or |
| 3653 | sPLT, only the n'th item in the structure is freed, where n is "seq". |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3654 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3655 | If you allocated data such as a palette that you passed in to libpng |
| 3656 | with png_set_*, you must not free it until just before the call to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3657 | png_destroy_write_struct(). |
| 3658 | |
| 3659 | The default behavior is only to free data that was allocated internally |
| 3660 | by libpng. This can be changed, so that libpng will not free the data, |
| 3661 | or so that it will free data that was allocated by the user with png_malloc() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3662 | or png_calloc() and passed in via a png_set_*() function, with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3663 | |
| 3664 | png_data_freer(png_ptr, info_ptr, freer, mask) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3665 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3666 | freer - one of |
| 3667 | PNG_DESTROY_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 3668 | PNG_SET_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 3669 | PNG_USER_WILL_FREE_DATA |
| 3670 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3671 | mask - which data elements are affected |
| 3672 | same choices as in png_free_data() |
| 3673 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3674 | For example, to transfer responsibility for some data from a read structure |
| 3675 | to a write structure, you could use |
| 3676 | |
| 3677 | png_data_freer(read_ptr, read_info_ptr, |
| 3678 | PNG_USER_WILL_FREE_DATA, |
| 3679 | PNG_FREE_PLTE|PNG_FREE_tRNS|PNG_FREE_hIST) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3680 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3681 | png_data_freer(write_ptr, write_info_ptr, |
| 3682 | PNG_DESTROY_WILL_FREE_DATA, |
| 3683 | PNG_FREE_PLTE|PNG_FREE_tRNS|PNG_FREE_hIST) |
| 3684 | |
| 3685 | thereby briefly reassigning responsibility for freeing to the user but |
| 3686 | immediately afterwards reassigning it once more to the write_destroy |
| 3687 | function. Having done this, it would then be safe to destroy the read |
| 3688 | structure and continue to use the PLTE, tRNS, and hIST data in the write |
| 3689 | structure. |
| 3690 | |
| 3691 | This function only affects data that has already been allocated. |
| 3692 | You can call this function before calling after the png_set_*() functions |
| 3693 | to control whether the user or png_destroy_*() is supposed to free the data. |
| 3694 | When the user assumes responsibility for libpng-allocated data, the |
| 3695 | application must use |
| 3696 | png_free() to free it, and when the user transfers responsibility to libpng |
| 3697 | for data that the user has allocated, the user must have used png_malloc() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3698 | or png_calloc() to allocate it. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3699 | |
| 3700 | If you allocated text_ptr.text, text_ptr.lang, and text_ptr.translated_keyword |
| 3701 | separately, do not transfer responsibility for freeing text_ptr to libpng, |
| 3702 | because when libpng fills a png_text structure it combines these members with |
| 3703 | the key member, and png_free_data() will free only text_ptr.key. Similarly, |
| 3704 | if you transfer responsibility for free'ing text_ptr from libpng to your |
| 3705 | application, your application must not separately free those members. |
| 3706 | For a more compact example of writing a PNG image, see the file example.c. |
| 3707 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3708 | V. Simplified API |
| 3709 | |
| 3710 | The simplified API, which became available in libpng-1.6.0, hides the details |
| 3711 | of both libpng and the PNG file format itself. |
| 3712 | It allows PNG files to be read into a very limited number of |
| 3713 | in-memory bitmap formats or to be written from the same formats. If these |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3714 | formats do not accommodate your needs then you can, and should, use the more |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3715 | sophisticated APIs above - these support a wide variety of in-memory formats |
| 3716 | and a wide variety of sophisticated transformations to those formats as well |
| 3717 | as a wide variety of APIs to manipulate ancilliary information. |
| 3718 | |
| 3719 | To read a PNG file using the simplified API: |
| 3720 | |
| 3721 | 1) Declare a 'png_image' structure (see below) on the |
| 3722 | stack and memset() it to all zero. |
| 3723 | |
| 3724 | 2) Call the appropriate png_image_begin_read... function. |
| 3725 | |
| 3726 | 3) Set the png_image 'format' member to the required |
| 3727 | format and allocate a buffer for the image. |
| 3728 | |
| 3729 | 4) Call png_image_finish_read to read the image into |
| 3730 | your buffer. |
| 3731 | |
| 3732 | There are no restrictions on the format of the PNG input itself; all valid |
| 3733 | color types, bit depths, and interlace methods are acceptable, and the |
| 3734 | input image is transformed as necessary to the requested in-memory format |
| 3735 | during the png_image_finish_read() step. |
| 3736 | |
| 3737 | To write a PNG file using the simplified API: |
| 3738 | |
| 3739 | 1) Declare a 'png_image' structure on the stack and memset() |
| 3740 | it to all zero. |
| 3741 | |
| 3742 | 2) Initialize the members of the structure that describe the |
| 3743 | image, setting the 'format' member to the format of the |
| 3744 | image in memory. |
| 3745 | |
| 3746 | 3) Call the appropriate png_image_write... function with a |
| 3747 | pointer to the image to write the PNG data. |
| 3748 | |
| 3749 | png_image is a structure that describes the in-memory format of an image |
| 3750 | when it is being read or define the in-memory format of an image that you |
| 3751 | need to write. The "png_image" structure contains the following members: |
| 3752 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3753 | png_uint_32 version Set to PNG_IMAGE_VERSION |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3754 | png_uint_32 width Image width in pixels (columns) |
| 3755 | png_uint_32 height Image height in pixels (rows) |
| 3756 | png_uint_32 format Image format as defined below |
| 3757 | png_uint_32 flags A bit mask containing informational flags |
| 3758 | png_controlp opaque Initialize to NULL, free with png_image_free |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3759 | png_uint_32 colormap_entries; Number of entries in the color-map |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3760 | png_uint_32 warning_or_error; |
| 3761 | char message[64]; |
| 3762 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3763 | In the event of an error or warning the following field warning_or_error |
| 3764 | field will be set to a non-zero value and the 'message' field will contain |
| 3765 | a '\0' terminated string with the libpng error or warning message. If both |
| 3766 | warnings and an error were encountered, only the error is recorded. If there |
| 3767 | are multiple warnings, only the first one is recorded. |
| 3768 | |
| 3769 | The upper 30 bits of this value are reserved; the low two bits contain |
| 3770 | a two bit code such that a value more than 1 indicates a failure in the API |
| 3771 | just called: |
| 3772 | |
| 3773 | 0 - no warning or error |
| 3774 | 1 - warning |
| 3775 | 2 - error |
| 3776 | 3 - error preceded by warning |
| 3777 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3778 | The pixels (samples) of the image have one to four channels whose components |
| 3779 | have original values in the range 0 to 1.0: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3780 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3781 | 1: A single gray or luminance channel (G). |
| 3782 | 2: A gray/luminance channel and an alpha channel (GA). |
| 3783 | 3: Three red, green, blue color channels (RGB). |
| 3784 | 4: Three color channels and an alpha channel (RGBA). |
| 3785 | |
| 3786 | The channels are encoded in one of two ways: |
| 3787 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3788 | a) As a small integer, value 0..255, contained in a single byte. For the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3789 | alpha channel the original value is simply value/255. For the color or |
| 3790 | luminance channels the value is encoded according to the sRGB specification |
| 3791 | and matches the 8-bit format expected by typical display devices. |
| 3792 | |
| 3793 | The color/gray channels are not scaled (pre-multiplied) by the alpha |
| 3794 | channel and are suitable for passing to color management software. |
| 3795 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3796 | b) As a value in the range 0..65535, contained in a 2-byte integer, in |
| 3797 | the native byte order of the platform on which the application is running. |
| 3798 | All channels can be converted to the original value by dividing by 65535; all |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3799 | channels are linear. Color channels use the RGB encoding (RGB end-points) of |
| 3800 | the sRGB specification. This encoding is identified by the |
| 3801 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR flag below. |
| 3802 | |
| 3803 | When an alpha channel is present it is expected to denote pixel coverage |
| 3804 | of the color or luminance channels and is returned as an associated alpha |
| 3805 | channel: the color/gray channels are scaled (pre-multiplied) by the alpha |
| 3806 | value. |
| 3807 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3808 | When a color-mapped image is used as a result of calling |
| 3809 | png_image_read_colormap or png_image_write_colormap the channels are encoded |
| 3810 | in the color-map and the descriptions above apply to the color-map entries. |
| 3811 | The image data is encoded as small integers, value 0..255, that index the |
| 3812 | entries in the color-map. One integer (one byte) is stored for each pixel. |
| 3813 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3814 | PNG_FORMAT_* |
| 3815 | |
| 3816 | The #defines to be used in png_image::format. Each #define identifies a |
| 3817 | particular layout of channel data and, if present, alpha values. There are |
| 3818 | separate defines for each of the two channel encodings. |
| 3819 | |
| 3820 | A format is built up using single bit flag values. Not all combinations are |
| 3821 | valid: use the bit flag values below for testing a format returned by the |
| 3822 | read APIs, but set formats from the derived values. |
| 3823 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3824 | When reading or writing color-mapped images the format should be set to the |
| 3825 | format of the entries in the color-map then png_image_{read,write}_colormap |
| 3826 | called to read or write the color-map and set the format correctly for the |
| 3827 | image data. Do not set the PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLORMAP bit directly! |
| 3828 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3829 | NOTE: libpng can be built with particular features disabled, if you see |
| 3830 | compiler errors because the definition of one of the following flags has been |
| 3831 | compiled out it is because libpng does not have the required support. It is |
| 3832 | possible, however, for the libpng configuration to enable the format on just |
| 3833 | read or just write; in that case you may see an error at run time. You can |
| 3834 | guard against this by checking for the definition of: |
| 3835 | |
| 3836 | PNG_SIMPLIFIED_{READ,WRITE}_{BGR,AFIRST}_SUPPORTED |
| 3837 | |
| 3838 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA 0x01 format with an alpha channel |
| 3839 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLOR 0x02 color format: otherwise grayscale |
| 3840 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR 0x04 png_uint_16 channels else png_byte |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3841 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLORMAP 0x08 libpng use only |
| 3842 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_BGR 0x10 BGR colors, else order is RGB |
| 3843 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_AFIRST 0x20 alpha channel comes first |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3844 | |
| 3845 | Supported formats are as follows. Future versions of libpng may support more |
| 3846 | formats; for compatibility with older versions simply check if the format |
| 3847 | macro is defined using #ifdef. These defines describe the in-memory layout |
| 3848 | of the components of the pixels of the image. |
| 3849 | |
| 3850 | First the single byte formats: |
| 3851 | |
| 3852 | PNG_FORMAT_GRAY 0 |
| 3853 | PNG_FORMAT_GA PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA |
| 3854 | PNG_FORMAT_AG (PNG_FORMAT_GA|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_AFIRST) |
| 3855 | PNG_FORMAT_RGB PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLOR |
| 3856 | PNG_FORMAT_BGR (PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLOR|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_BGR) |
| 3857 | PNG_FORMAT_RGBA (PNG_FORMAT_RGB|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA) |
| 3858 | PNG_FORMAT_ARGB (PNG_FORMAT_RGBA|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_AFIRST) |
| 3859 | PNG_FORMAT_BGRA (PNG_FORMAT_BGR|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA) |
| 3860 | PNG_FORMAT_ABGR (PNG_FORMAT_BGRA|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_AFIRST) |
| 3861 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3862 | Then the linear 2-byte formats. When naming these "Y" is used to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3863 | indicate a luminance (gray) channel. The component order within the pixel |
| 3864 | is always the same - there is no provision for swapping the order of the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3865 | components in the linear format. The components are 16-bit integers in |
| 3866 | the native byte order for your platform, and there is no provision for |
| 3867 | swapping the bytes to a different endian condition. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3868 | |
| 3869 | PNG_FORMAT_LINEAR_Y PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR |
| 3870 | PNG_FORMAT_LINEAR_Y_ALPHA |
| 3871 | (PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA) |
| 3872 | PNG_FORMAT_LINEAR_RGB |
| 3873 | (PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLOR) |
| 3874 | PNG_FORMAT_LINEAR_RGB_ALPHA |
| 3875 | (PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_LINEAR|PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLOR| |
| 3876 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_ALPHA) |
| 3877 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3878 | Color-mapped formats are obtained by calling png_image_{read,write}_colormap, |
| 3879 | as appropriate after setting png_image::format to the format of the color-map |
| 3880 | to be read or written. Applications may check the value of |
| 3881 | PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLORMAP to see if they have called the colormap API. The |
| 3882 | format of the color-map may be extracted using the following macro. |
| 3883 | |
| 3884 | PNG_FORMAT_OF_COLORMAP(fmt) ((fmt) & ~PNG_FORMAT_FLAG_COLORMAP) |
| 3885 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3886 | PNG_IMAGE macros |
| 3887 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3888 | These are convenience macros to derive information from a png_image |
| 3889 | structure. The PNG_IMAGE_SAMPLE_ macros return values appropriate to the |
| 3890 | actual image sample values - either the entries in the color-map or the |
| 3891 | pixels in the image. The PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_ macros return corresponding values |
| 3892 | for the pixels and will always return 1 after a call to |
| 3893 | png_image_{read,write}_colormap. The remaining macros return information |
| 3894 | about the rows in the image and the complete image. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3895 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3896 | NOTE: All the macros that take a png_image::format parameter are compile time |
| 3897 | constants if the format parameter is, itself, a constant. Therefore these |
| 3898 | macros can be used in array declarations and case labels where required. |
| 3899 | Similarly the macros are also pre-processor constants (sizeof is not used) so |
| 3900 | they can be used in #if tests. |
| 3901 | |
| 3902 | First the information about the samples. |
| 3903 | |
| 3904 | PNG_IMAGE_SAMPLE_CHANNELS(fmt) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3905 | Returns the total number of channels in a given format: 1..4 |
| 3906 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3907 | PNG_IMAGE_SAMPLE_COMPONENT_SIZE(fmt) |
| 3908 | Returns the size in bytes of a single component of a pixel or color-map |
| 3909 | entry (as appropriate) in the image. |
| 3910 | |
| 3911 | PNG_IMAGE_SAMPLE_SIZE(fmt) |
| 3912 | This is the size of the sample data for one sample. If the image is |
| 3913 | color-mapped it is the size of one color-map entry (and image pixels are |
| 3914 | one byte in size), otherwise it is the size of one image pixel. |
| 3915 | |
| 3916 | PNG_IMAGE_COLORMAP_SIZE(fmt) |
| 3917 | The size of the color-map required by the format; this is the size of the |
| 3918 | color-map buffer passed to the png_image_{read,write}_colormap APIs, it is |
| 3919 | a fixed number determined by the format so can easily be allocated on the |
| 3920 | stack if necessary. |
| 3921 | |
| 3922 | #define PNG_IMAGE_MAXIMUM_COLORMAP_COMPONENTS(fmt)\ |
| 3923 | (PNG_IMAGE_SAMPLE_CHANNELS(fmt) * 256) |
| 3924 | /* The maximum size of the color-map required by the format expressed in a |
| 3925 | * count of components. This can be used to compile-time allocate a |
| 3926 | * color-map: |
| 3927 | * |
| 3928 | * png_uint_16 colormap[PNG_IMAGE_MAXIMUM_COLORMAP_COMPONENTS(linear_fmt)]; |
| 3929 | * |
| 3930 | * png_byte colormap[PNG_IMAGE_MAXIMUM_COLORMAP_COMPONENTS(sRGB_fmt)]; |
| 3931 | * |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3932 | * Alternatively, use the PNG_IMAGE_COLORMAP_SIZE macro below to use the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3933 | * information from one of the png_image_begin_read_ APIs and dynamically |
| 3934 | * allocate the required memory. |
| 3935 | */ |
| 3936 | |
| 3937 | |
| 3938 | Corresponding information about the pixels |
| 3939 | |
| 3940 | PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_(test,fmt) |
| 3941 | |
| 3942 | PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_CHANNELS(fmt) |
| 3943 | The number of separate channels (components) in a pixel; 1 for a |
| 3944 | color-mapped image. |
| 3945 | |
| 3946 | PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_COMPONENT_SIZE(fmt)\ |
| 3947 | The size, in bytes, of each component in a pixel; 1 for a color-mapped |
| 3948 | image. |
John Bowler | 6f237b6 | 2012-03-02 13:13:15 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3949 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3950 | PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_SIZE(fmt) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3951 | The size, in bytes, of a complete pixel; 1 for a color-mapped image. |
| 3952 | |
| 3953 | Information about the whole row, or whole image |
| 3954 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3955 | PNG_IMAGE_ROW_STRIDE(image) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3956 | Returns the total number of components in a single row of the image; this |
| 3957 | is the minimum 'row stride', the minimum count of components between each |
| 3958 | row. For a color-mapped image this is the minimum number of bytes in a |
| 3959 | row. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3960 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3961 | If you need the stride measured in bytes, row_stride_bytes is |
| 3962 | PNG_IMAGE_ROW_STRIDE(image) * PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_COMPONENT_SIZE(fmt) |
| 3963 | plus any padding bytes that your application might need, for example |
| 3964 | to start the next row on a 4-byte boundary. |
| 3965 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3966 | PNG_IMAGE_BUFFER_SIZE(image, row_stride) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3967 | Returns the size, in bytes, of an image buffer given a png_image and a row |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 3968 | stride - the number of components to leave space for in each row. This |
| 3969 | macro takes care of multiplying row_stride by PNG_IMAGE_PIXEL_COMONENT_SIZE |
| 3970 | when the image has 2-byte components. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3971 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3972 | PNG_IMAGE_FLAG_COLORSPACE_NOT_sRGB == 0x01 |
| 3973 | This indicates the the RGB values of the in-memory bitmap do not |
| 3974 | correspond to the red, green and blue end-points defined by sRGB. |
John Bowler | 6f237b6 | 2012-03-02 13:13:15 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3975 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3976 | PNG_IMAGE_FLAG_COLORMAP == 0x02 |
| 3977 | The PNG is color-mapped. If this flag is set png_image_read_colormap |
| 3978 | can be used without further loss of image information. If it is not set |
| 3979 | png_image_read_colormap will cause significant loss if the image has any |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3980 | |
| 3981 | READ APIs |
| 3982 | |
| 3983 | The png_image passed to the read APIs must have been initialized by setting |
| 3984 | the png_controlp field 'opaque' to NULL (or, better, memset the whole thing.) |
| 3985 | |
| 3986 | int png_image_begin_read_from_file( png_imagep image, |
| 3987 | const char *file_name) |
| 3988 | |
| 3989 | The named file is opened for read and the image header |
| 3990 | is filled in from the PNG header in the file. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 3991 | |
| 3992 | int png_image_begin_read_from_stdio (png_imagep image, |
| 3993 | FILE* file) |
| 3994 | |
| 3995 | The PNG header is read from the stdio FILE object. |
| 3996 | |
| 3997 | int png_image_begin_read_from_memory(png_imagep image, |
| 3998 | png_const_voidp memory, png_size_t size) |
| 3999 | |
| 4000 | The PNG header is read from the given memory buffer. |
| 4001 | |
| 4002 | int png_image_finish_read(png_imagep image, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4003 | png_colorp background, void *buffer, |
| 4004 | png_int_32 row_stride, void *colormap)); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4005 | |
| 4006 | Finish reading the image into the supplied buffer and |
| 4007 | clean up the png_image structure. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4008 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4009 | row_stride is the step, in png_byte or png_uint_16 units |
| 4010 | as appropriate, between adjacent rows. A positive stride |
| 4011 | indicates that the top-most row is first in the buffer - |
| 4012 | the normal top-down arrangement. A negative stride |
| 4013 | indicates that the bottom-most row is first in the buffer. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4014 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4015 | background need only be supplied if an alpha channel must |
| 4016 | be removed from a png_byte format and the removal is to be |
| 4017 | done by compositing on a solid color; otherwise it may be |
| 4018 | NULL and any composition will be done directly onto the |
| 4019 | buffer. The value is an sRGB color to use for the |
| 4020 | background, for grayscale output the green channel is used. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4021 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4022 | For linear output removing the alpha channel is always done |
| 4023 | by compositing on black. |
| 4024 | |
| 4025 | void png_image_free(png_imagep image) |
| 4026 | |
| 4027 | Free any data allocated by libpng in image->opaque, |
| 4028 | setting the pointer to NULL. May be called at any time |
| 4029 | after the structure is initialized. |
| 4030 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4031 | When the simplified API needs to convert between sRGB and linear colorspaces, |
| 4032 | the actual sRGB transfer curve defined in the sRGB specification (see the |
| 4033 | article at http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SRGB) is used, not the gamma=1/2.2 |
| 4034 | approximation used elsewhere in libpng. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4035 | |
| 4036 | WRITE APIS |
| 4037 | |
| 4038 | For write you must initialize a png_image structure to describe the image to |
| 4039 | be written: |
| 4040 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4041 | version: must be set to PNG_IMAGE_VERSION |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4042 | opaque: must be initialized to NULL |
| 4043 | width: image width in pixels |
| 4044 | height: image height in rows |
| 4045 | format: the format of the data you wish to write |
| 4046 | flags: set to 0 unless one of the defined flags applies; set |
| 4047 | PNG_IMAGE_FLAG_COLORSPACE_NOT_sRGB for color format images |
| 4048 | where the RGB values do not correspond to the colors in sRGB. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4049 | colormap_entries: set to the number of entries in the color-map (0 to 256) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4050 | |
| 4051 | int png_image_write_to_file, (png_imagep image, |
| 4052 | const char *file, int convert_to_8bit, const void *buffer, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4053 | png_int_32 row_stride, const void *colormap)); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4054 | |
| 4055 | Write the image to the named file. |
| 4056 | |
| 4057 | int png_image_write_to_stdio(png_imagep image, FILE *file, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4058 | int convert_to_8_bit, const void *buffer, |
| 4059 | png_int_32 row_stride, const void *colormap) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4060 | |
| 4061 | Write the image to the given (FILE*). |
| 4062 | |
| 4063 | With all write APIs if image is in one of the linear formats with |
| 4064 | (png_uint_16) data then setting convert_to_8_bit will cause the output to be |
| 4065 | a (png_byte) PNG gamma encoded according to the sRGB specification, otherwise |
| 4066 | a 16-bit linear encoded PNG file is written. |
| 4067 | |
| 4068 | With all APIs row_stride is handled as in the read APIs - it is the spacing |
| 4069 | from one row to the next in component sized units (float) and if negative |
| 4070 | indicates a bottom-up row layout in the buffer. |
| 4071 | |
| 4072 | Note that the write API does not support interlacing, sub-8-bit pixels, |
| 4073 | and indexed (paletted) images. |
| 4074 | |
| 4075 | VI. Modifying/Customizing libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4076 | |
| 4077 | There are two issues here. The first is changing how libpng does |
| 4078 | standard things like memory allocation, input/output, and error handling. |
| 4079 | The second deals with more complicated things like adding new chunks, |
| 4080 | adding new transformations, and generally changing how libpng works. |
| 4081 | Both of those are compile-time issues; that is, they are generally |
| 4082 | determined at the time the code is written, and there is rarely a need |
| 4083 | to provide the user with a means of changing them. |
| 4084 | |
| 4085 | Memory allocation, input/output, and error handling |
| 4086 | |
| 4087 | All of the memory allocation, input/output, and error handling in libpng |
| 4088 | goes through callbacks that are user-settable. The default routines are |
| 4089 | in pngmem.c, pngrio.c, pngwio.c, and pngerror.c, respectively. To change |
| 4090 | these functions, call the appropriate png_set_*_fn() function. |
| 4091 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4092 | Memory allocation is done through the functions png_malloc(), png_calloc(), |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4093 | and png_free(). The png_malloc() and png_free() functions currently just |
| 4094 | call the standard C functions and png_calloc() calls png_malloc() and then |
| 4095 | clears the newly allocated memory to zero; note that png_calloc(png_ptr, size) |
| 4096 | is not the same as the calloc(number, size) function provided by stdlib.h. |
| 4097 | There is limited support for certain systems with segmented memory |
| 4098 | architectures and the types of pointers declared by png.h match this; you |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4099 | will have to use appropriate pointers in your application. If you prefer |
| 4100 | to use a different method of allocating and freeing data, you can use |
| 4101 | png_create_read_struct_2() or png_create_write_struct_2() to register your |
| 4102 | own functions as described above. These functions also provide a void |
| 4103 | pointer that can be retrieved via |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4104 | |
| 4105 | mem_ptr=png_get_mem_ptr(png_ptr); |
| 4106 | |
| 4107 | Your replacement memory functions must have prototypes as follows: |
| 4108 | |
| 4109 | png_voidp malloc_fn(png_structp png_ptr, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4110 | png_alloc_size_t size); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4111 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4112 | void free_fn(png_structp png_ptr, png_voidp ptr); |
| 4113 | |
| 4114 | Your malloc_fn() must return NULL in case of failure. The png_malloc() |
| 4115 | function will normally call png_error() if it receives a NULL from the |
| 4116 | system memory allocator or from your replacement malloc_fn(). |
| 4117 | |
| 4118 | Your free_fn() will never be called with a NULL ptr, since libpng's |
| 4119 | png_free() checks for NULL before calling free_fn(). |
| 4120 | |
| 4121 | Input/Output in libpng is done through png_read() and png_write(), |
| 4122 | which currently just call fread() and fwrite(). The FILE * is stored in |
| 4123 | png_struct and is initialized via png_init_io(). If you wish to change |
| 4124 | the method of I/O, the library supplies callbacks that you can set |
| 4125 | through the function png_set_read_fn() and png_set_write_fn() at run |
| 4126 | time, instead of calling the png_init_io() function. These functions |
| 4127 | also provide a void pointer that can be retrieved via the function |
| 4128 | png_get_io_ptr(). For example: |
| 4129 | |
| 4130 | png_set_read_fn(png_structp read_ptr, |
| 4131 | voidp read_io_ptr, png_rw_ptr read_data_fn) |
| 4132 | |
| 4133 | png_set_write_fn(png_structp write_ptr, |
| 4134 | voidp write_io_ptr, png_rw_ptr write_data_fn, |
| 4135 | png_flush_ptr output_flush_fn); |
| 4136 | |
| 4137 | voidp read_io_ptr = png_get_io_ptr(read_ptr); |
| 4138 | voidp write_io_ptr = png_get_io_ptr(write_ptr); |
| 4139 | |
| 4140 | The replacement I/O functions must have prototypes as follows: |
| 4141 | |
| 4142 | void user_read_data(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 4143 | png_bytep data, png_size_t length); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4144 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4145 | void user_write_data(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 4146 | png_bytep data, png_size_t length); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4147 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4148 | void user_flush_data(png_structp png_ptr); |
| 4149 | |
| 4150 | The user_read_data() function is responsible for detecting and |
| 4151 | handling end-of-data errors. |
| 4152 | |
| 4153 | Supplying NULL for the read, write, or flush functions sets them back |
| 4154 | to using the default C stream functions, which expect the io_ptr to |
| 4155 | point to a standard *FILE structure. It is probably a mistake |
| 4156 | to use NULL for one of write_data_fn and output_flush_fn but not both |
| 4157 | of them, unless you have built libpng with PNG_NO_WRITE_FLUSH defined. |
| 4158 | It is an error to read from a write stream, and vice versa. |
| 4159 | |
| 4160 | Error handling in libpng is done through png_error() and png_warning(). |
| 4161 | Errors handled through png_error() are fatal, meaning that png_error() |
| 4162 | should never return to its caller. Currently, this is handled via |
| 4163 | setjmp() and longjmp() (unless you have compiled libpng with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4164 | PNG_NO_SETJMP, in which case it is handled via PNG_ABORT()), |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6098807 | 2010-04-13 22:11:06 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4165 | but you could change this to do things like exit() if you should wish, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 54ac9a9 | 2010-04-02 17:06:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4166 | as long as your function does not return. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4167 | |
| 4168 | On non-fatal errors, png_warning() is called |
| 4169 | to print a warning message, and then control returns to the calling code. |
| 4170 | By default png_error() and png_warning() print a message on stderr via |
| 4171 | fprintf() unless the library is compiled with PNG_NO_CONSOLE_IO defined |
| 4172 | (because you don't want the messages) or PNG_NO_STDIO defined (because |
| 4173 | fprintf() isn't available). If you wish to change the behavior of the error |
| 4174 | functions, you will need to set up your own message callbacks. These |
| 4175 | functions are normally supplied at the time that the png_struct is created. |
| 4176 | It is also possible to redirect errors and warnings to your own replacement |
| 4177 | functions after png_create_*_struct() has been called by calling: |
| 4178 | |
| 4179 | png_set_error_fn(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 4180 | png_voidp error_ptr, png_error_ptr error_fn, |
| 4181 | png_error_ptr warning_fn); |
| 4182 | |
| 4183 | png_voidp error_ptr = png_get_error_ptr(png_ptr); |
| 4184 | |
| 4185 | If NULL is supplied for either error_fn or warning_fn, then the libpng |
| 4186 | default function will be used, calling fprintf() and/or longjmp() if a |
| 4187 | problem is encountered. The replacement error functions should have |
| 4188 | parameters as follows: |
| 4189 | |
| 4190 | void user_error_fn(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 4191 | png_const_charp error_msg); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4192 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4193 | void user_warning_fn(png_structp png_ptr, |
| 4194 | png_const_charp warning_msg); |
| 4195 | |
| 4196 | The motivation behind using setjmp() and longjmp() is the C++ throw and |
| 4197 | catch exception handling methods. This makes the code much easier to write, |
| 4198 | as there is no need to check every return code of every function call. |
| 4199 | However, there are some uncertainties about the status of local variables |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4200 | after a longjmp, so the user may want to be careful about doing anything |
| 4201 | after setjmp returns non-zero besides returning itself. Consult your |
| 4202 | compiler documentation for more details. For an alternative approach, you |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4203 | may wish to use the "cexcept" facility (see http://cexcept.sourceforge.net), |
| 4204 | which is illustrated in pngvalid.c and in contrib/visupng. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4205 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4206 | Beginning in libpng-1.4.0, the png_set_benign_errors() API became available. |
| 4207 | You can use this to handle certain errors (normally handled as errors) |
| 4208 | as warnings. |
| 4209 | |
| 4210 | png_set_benign_errors (png_ptr, int allowed); |
| 4211 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4212 | allowed: 0: treat png_benign_error() as an error. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4213 | 1: treat png_benign_error() as a warning. |
| 4214 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4215 | As of libpng-1.6.0, the default condition is to treat benign errors as |
| 4216 | warnings while reading and as errors while writing. |
| 4217 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4218 | Custom chunks |
| 4219 | |
| 4220 | If you need to read or write custom chunks, you may need to get deeper |
| 4221 | into the libpng code. The library now has mechanisms for storing |
| 4222 | and writing chunks of unknown type; you can even declare callbacks |
| 4223 | for custom chunks. However, this may not be good enough if the |
| 4224 | library code itself needs to know about interactions between your |
| 4225 | chunk and existing `intrinsic' chunks. |
| 4226 | |
| 4227 | If you need to write a new intrinsic chunk, first read the PNG |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4228 | specification. Acquire a first level of understanding of how it works. |
| 4229 | Pay particular attention to the sections that describe chunk names, |
| 4230 | and look at how other chunks were designed, so you can do things |
| 4231 | similarly. Second, check out the sections of libpng that read and |
| 4232 | write chunks. Try to find a chunk that is similar to yours and use |
| 4233 | it as a template. More details can be found in the comments inside |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4234 | the code. It is best to handle private or unknown chunks in a generic method, |
| 4235 | via callback functions, instead of by modifying libpng functions. This |
| 4236 | is illustrated in pngtest.c, which uses a callback function to handle a |
| 4237 | private "vpAg" chunk and the new "sTER" chunk, which are both unknown to |
| 4238 | libpng. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4239 | |
| 4240 | If you wish to write your own transformation for the data, look through |
| 4241 | the part of the code that does the transformations, and check out some of |
| 4242 | the simpler ones to get an idea of how they work. Try to find a similar |
| 4243 | transformation to the one you want to add and copy off of it. More details |
| 4244 | can be found in the comments inside the code itself. |
| 4245 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4246 | Configuring for gui/windowing platforms: |
| 4247 | |
| 4248 | You will need to write new error and warning functions that use the GUI |
| 4249 | interface, as described previously, and set them to be the error and |
| 4250 | warning functions at the time that png_create_*_struct() is called, |
| 4251 | in order to have them available during the structure initialization. |
| 4252 | They can be changed later via png_set_error_fn(). On some compilers, |
| 4253 | you may also have to change the memory allocators (png_malloc, etc.). |
| 4254 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4255 | Configuring zlib: |
| 4256 | |
| 4257 | There are special functions to configure the compression. Perhaps the |
| 4258 | most useful one changes the compression level, which currently uses |
| 4259 | input compression values in the range 0 - 9. The library normally |
| 4260 | uses the default compression level (Z_DEFAULT_COMPRESSION = 6). Tests |
| 4261 | have shown that for a large majority of images, compression values in |
| 4262 | the range 3-6 compress nearly as well as higher levels, and do so much |
| 4263 | faster. For online applications it may be desirable to have maximum speed |
| 4264 | (Z_BEST_SPEED = 1). With versions of zlib after v0.99, you can also |
| 4265 | specify no compression (Z_NO_COMPRESSION = 0), but this would create |
| 4266 | files larger than just storing the raw bitmap. You can specify the |
| 4267 | compression level by calling: |
| 4268 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 38734ee | 2011-03-03 06:23:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4269 | #include zlib.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4270 | png_set_compression_level(png_ptr, level); |
| 4271 | |
| 4272 | Another useful one is to reduce the memory level used by the library. |
| 4273 | The memory level defaults to 8, but it can be lowered if you are |
| 4274 | short on memory (running DOS, for example, where you only have 640K). |
| 4275 | Note that the memory level does have an effect on compression; among |
| 4276 | other things, lower levels will result in sections of incompressible |
| 4277 | data being emitted in smaller stored blocks, with a correspondingly |
| 4278 | larger relative overhead of up to 15% in the worst case. |
| 4279 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 38734ee | 2011-03-03 06:23:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4280 | #include zlib.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4281 | png_set_compression_mem_level(png_ptr, level); |
| 4282 | |
| 4283 | The other functions are for configuring zlib. They are not recommended |
| 4284 | for normal use and may result in writing an invalid PNG file. See |
| 4285 | zlib.h for more information on what these mean. |
| 4286 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 38734ee | 2011-03-03 06:23:31 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4287 | #include zlib.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4288 | png_set_compression_strategy(png_ptr, |
| 4289 | strategy); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4290 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4291 | png_set_compression_window_bits(png_ptr, |
| 4292 | window_bits); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4293 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4294 | png_set_compression_method(png_ptr, method); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4295 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6b570f1 | 2014-03-25 10:31:12 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4296 | This controls the size of the IDAT chunks (default 8192): |
| 4297 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4298 | png_set_compression_buffer_size(png_ptr, size); |
| 4299 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4300 | As of libpng version 1.5.4, additional APIs became |
| 4301 | available to set these separately for non-IDAT |
| 4302 | compressed chunks such as zTXt, iTXt, and iCCP: |
| 4303 | |
| 4304 | #include zlib.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4305 | #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a28724 | 2011-07-26 12:03:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4306 | png_set_text_compression_level(png_ptr, level); |
| 4307 | |
| 4308 | png_set_text_compression_mem_level(png_ptr, level); |
| 4309 | |
| 4310 | png_set_text_compression_strategy(png_ptr, |
| 4311 | strategy); |
| 4312 | |
| 4313 | png_set_text_compression_window_bits(png_ptr, |
| 4314 | window_bits); |
| 4315 | |
| 4316 | png_set_text_compression_method(png_ptr, method); |
| 4317 | #endif |
| 4318 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4319 | Controlling row filtering |
| 4320 | |
| 4321 | If you want to control whether libpng uses filtering or not, which |
| 4322 | filters are used, and how it goes about picking row filters, you |
| 4323 | can call one of these functions. The selection and configuration |
| 4324 | of row filters can have a significant impact on the size and |
| 4325 | encoding speed and a somewhat lesser impact on the decoding speed |
| 4326 | of an image. Filtering is enabled by default for RGB and grayscale |
| 4327 | images (with and without alpha), but not for paletted images nor |
| 4328 | for any images with bit depths less than 8 bits/pixel. |
| 4329 | |
| 4330 | The 'method' parameter sets the main filtering method, which is |
| 4331 | currently only '0' in the PNG 1.2 specification. The 'filters' |
| 4332 | parameter sets which filter(s), if any, should be used for each |
| 4333 | scanline. Possible values are PNG_ALL_FILTERS and PNG_NO_FILTERS |
| 4334 | to turn filtering on and off, respectively. |
| 4335 | |
| 4336 | Individual filter types are PNG_FILTER_NONE, PNG_FILTER_SUB, |
| 4337 | PNG_FILTER_UP, PNG_FILTER_AVG, PNG_FILTER_PAETH, which can be bitwise |
| 4338 | ORed together with '|' to specify one or more filters to use. |
| 4339 | These filters are described in more detail in the PNG specification. |
| 4340 | If you intend to change the filter type during the course of writing |
| 4341 | the image, you should start with flags set for all of the filters |
| 4342 | you intend to use so that libpng can initialize its internal |
| 4343 | structures appropriately for all of the filter types. (Note that this |
| 4344 | means the first row must always be adaptively filtered, because libpng |
| 4345 | currently does not allocate the filter buffers until png_write_row() |
| 4346 | is called for the first time.) |
| 4347 | |
| 4348 | filters = PNG_FILTER_NONE | PNG_FILTER_SUB |
| 4349 | PNG_FILTER_UP | PNG_FILTER_AVG | |
| 4350 | PNG_FILTER_PAETH | PNG_ALL_FILTERS; |
| 4351 | |
| 4352 | png_set_filter(png_ptr, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE, |
| 4353 | filters); |
| 4354 | The second parameter can also be |
| 4355 | PNG_INTRAPIXEL_DIFFERENCING if you are |
| 4356 | writing a PNG to be embedded in a MNG |
| 4357 | datastream. This parameter must be the |
| 4358 | same as the value of filter_method used |
| 4359 | in png_set_IHDR(). |
| 4360 | |
| 4361 | It is also possible to influence how libpng chooses from among the |
| 4362 | available filters. This is done in one or both of two ways - by |
| 4363 | telling it how important it is to keep the same filter for successive |
| 4364 | rows, and by telling it the relative computational costs of the filters. |
| 4365 | |
| 4366 | double weights[3] = {1.5, 1.3, 1.1}, |
| 4367 | costs[PNG_FILTER_VALUE_LAST] = |
| 4368 | {1.0, 1.3, 1.3, 1.5, 1.7}; |
| 4369 | |
| 4370 | png_set_filter_heuristics(png_ptr, |
| 4371 | PNG_FILTER_HEURISTIC_WEIGHTED, 3, |
| 4372 | weights, costs); |
| 4373 | |
| 4374 | The weights are multiplying factors that indicate to libpng that the |
| 4375 | row filter should be the same for successive rows unless another row filter |
| 4376 | is that many times better than the previous filter. In the above example, |
| 4377 | if the previous 3 filters were SUB, SUB, NONE, the SUB filter could have a |
| 4378 | "sum of absolute differences" 1.5 x 1.3 times higher than other filters |
| 4379 | and still be chosen, while the NONE filter could have a sum 1.1 times |
| 4380 | higher than other filters and still be chosen. Unspecified weights are |
| 4381 | taken to be 1.0, and the specified weights should probably be declining |
| 4382 | like those above in order to emphasize recent filters over older filters. |
| 4383 | |
| 4384 | The filter costs specify for each filter type a relative decoding cost |
| 4385 | to be considered when selecting row filters. This means that filters |
| 4386 | with higher costs are less likely to be chosen over filters with lower |
| 4387 | costs, unless their "sum of absolute differences" is that much smaller. |
| 4388 | The costs do not necessarily reflect the exact computational speeds of |
| 4389 | the various filters, since this would unduly influence the final image |
| 4390 | size. |
| 4391 | |
| 4392 | Note that the numbers above were invented purely for this example and |
| 4393 | are given only to help explain the function usage. Little testing has |
| 4394 | been done to find optimum values for either the costs or the weights. |
| 4395 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4396 | Requesting debug printout |
| 4397 | |
| 4398 | The macro definition PNG_DEBUG can be used to request debugging |
| 4399 | printout. Set it to an integer value in the range 0 to 3. Higher |
| 4400 | numbers result in increasing amounts of debugging information. The |
| 4401 | information is printed to the "stderr" file, unless another file |
| 4402 | name is specified in the PNG_DEBUG_FILE macro definition. |
| 4403 | |
| 4404 | When PNG_DEBUG > 0, the following functions (macros) become available: |
| 4405 | |
| 4406 | png_debug(level, message) |
| 4407 | png_debug1(level, message, p1) |
| 4408 | png_debug2(level, message, p1, p2) |
| 4409 | |
| 4410 | in which "level" is compared to PNG_DEBUG to decide whether to print |
| 4411 | the message, "message" is the formatted string to be printed, |
| 4412 | and p1 and p2 are parameters that are to be embedded in the string |
| 4413 | according to printf-style formatting directives. For example, |
| 4414 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4415 | png_debug1(2, "foo=%d", foo); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4416 | |
| 4417 | is expanded to |
| 4418 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4419 | if (PNG_DEBUG > 2) |
| 4420 | fprintf(PNG_DEBUG_FILE, "foo=%d\n", foo); |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4421 | |
| 4422 | When PNG_DEBUG is defined but is zero, the macros aren't defined, but you |
| 4423 | can still use PNG_DEBUG to control your own debugging: |
| 4424 | |
| 4425 | #ifdef PNG_DEBUG |
| 4426 | fprintf(stderr, ... |
| 4427 | #endif |
| 4428 | |
| 4429 | When PNG_DEBUG = 1, the macros are defined, but only png_debug statements |
| 4430 | having level = 0 will be printed. There aren't any such statements in |
| 4431 | this version of libpng, but if you insert some they will be printed. |
| 4432 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4433 | VII. MNG support |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4434 | |
| 4435 | The MNG specification (available at http://www.libpng.org/pub/mng) allows |
| 4436 | certain extensions to PNG for PNG images that are embedded in MNG datastreams. |
| 4437 | Libpng can support some of these extensions. To enable them, use the |
| 4438 | png_permit_mng_features() function: |
| 4439 | |
| 4440 | feature_set = png_permit_mng_features(png_ptr, mask) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4441 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4442 | mask is a png_uint_32 containing the bitwise OR of the |
| 4443 | features you want to enable. These include |
| 4444 | PNG_FLAG_MNG_EMPTY_PLTE |
| 4445 | PNG_FLAG_MNG_FILTER_64 |
| 4446 | PNG_ALL_MNG_FEATURES |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4447 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4448 | feature_set is a png_uint_32 that is the bitwise AND of |
| 4449 | your mask with the set of MNG features that is |
| 4450 | supported by the version of libpng that you are using. |
| 4451 | |
| 4452 | It is an error to use this function when reading or writing a standalone |
| 4453 | PNG file with the PNG 8-byte signature. The PNG datastream must be wrapped |
| 4454 | in a MNG datastream. As a minimum, it must have the MNG 8-byte signature |
| 4455 | and the MHDR and MEND chunks. Libpng does not provide support for these |
| 4456 | or any other MNG chunks; your application must provide its own support for |
| 4457 | them. You may wish to consider using libmng (available at |
| 4458 | http://www.libmng.com) instead. |
| 4459 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4460 | VIII. Changes to Libpng from version 0.88 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4461 | |
| 4462 | It should be noted that versions of libpng later than 0.96 are not |
| 4463 | distributed by the original libpng author, Guy Schalnat, nor by |
| 4464 | Andreas Dilger, who had taken over from Guy during 1996 and 1997, and |
| 4465 | distributed versions 0.89 through 0.96, but rather by another member |
| 4466 | of the original PNG Group, Glenn Randers-Pehrson. Guy and Andreas are |
| 4467 | still alive and well, but they have moved on to other things. |
| 4468 | |
| 4469 | The old libpng functions png_read_init(), png_write_init(), |
| 4470 | png_info_init(), png_read_destroy(), and png_write_destroy() have been |
| 4471 | moved to PNG_INTERNAL in version 0.95 to discourage their use. These |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4472 | functions will be removed from libpng version 1.4.0. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4473 | |
| 4474 | The preferred method of creating and initializing the libpng structures is |
| 4475 | via the png_create_read_struct(), png_create_write_struct(), and |
| 4476 | png_create_info_struct() because they isolate the size of the structures |
| 4477 | from the application, allow version error checking, and also allow the |
| 4478 | use of custom error handling routines during the initialization, which |
| 4479 | the old functions do not. The functions png_read_destroy() and |
| 4480 | png_write_destroy() do not actually free the memory that libpng |
| 4481 | allocated for these structs, but just reset the data structures, so they |
| 4482 | can be used instead of png_destroy_read_struct() and |
| 4483 | png_destroy_write_struct() if you feel there is too much system overhead |
| 4484 | allocating and freeing the png_struct for each image read. |
| 4485 | |
| 4486 | Setting the error callbacks via png_set_message_fn() before |
| 4487 | png_read_init() as was suggested in libpng-0.88 is no longer supported |
| 4488 | because this caused applications that do not use custom error functions |
| 4489 | to fail if the png_ptr was not initialized to zero. It is still possible |
| 4490 | to set the error callbacks AFTER png_read_init(), or to change them with |
| 4491 | png_set_error_fn(), which is essentially the same function, but with a new |
| 4492 | name to force compilation errors with applications that try to use the old |
| 4493 | method. |
| 4494 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4495 | Support for the sCAL, iCCP, iTXt, and sPLT chunks was added at libpng-1.0.6; |
| 4496 | however, iTXt support was not enabled by default. |
| 4497 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4498 | Starting with version 1.0.7, you can find out which version of the library |
| 4499 | you are using at run-time: |
| 4500 | |
| 4501 | png_uint_32 libpng_vn = png_access_version_number(); |
| 4502 | |
| 4503 | The number libpng_vn is constructed from the major version, minor |
| 4504 | version with leading zero, and release number with leading zero, |
| 4505 | (e.g., libpng_vn for version 1.0.7 is 10007). |
| 4506 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4507 | Note that this function does not take a png_ptr, so you can call it |
| 4508 | before you've created one. |
| 4509 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4510 | You can also check which version of png.h you used when compiling your |
| 4511 | application: |
| 4512 | |
| 4513 | png_uint_32 application_vn = PNG_LIBPNG_VER; |
| 4514 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4515 | IX. Changes to Libpng from version 1.0.x to 1.2.x |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4516 | |
| 4517 | Support for user memory management was enabled by default. To |
| 4518 | accomplish this, the functions png_create_read_struct_2(), |
| 4519 | png_create_write_struct_2(), png_set_mem_fn(), png_get_mem_ptr(), |
| 4520 | png_malloc_default(), and png_free_default() were added. |
| 4521 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d6ea40a | 2009-11-02 07:32:00 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4522 | Support for the iTXt chunk has been enabled by default as of |
| 4523 | version 1.2.41. |
| 4524 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4525 | Support for certain MNG features was enabled. |
| 4526 | |
| 4527 | Support for numbered error messages was added. However, we never got |
| 4528 | around to actually numbering the error messages. The function |
| 4529 | png_set_strip_error_numbers() was added (Note: the prototype for this |
| 4530 | function was inadvertently removed from png.h in PNG_NO_ASSEMBLER_CODE |
| 4531 | builds of libpng-1.2.15. It was restored in libpng-1.2.36). |
| 4532 | |
| 4533 | The png_malloc_warn() function was added at libpng-1.2.3. This issues |
| 4534 | a png_warning and returns NULL instead of aborting when it fails to |
| 4535 | acquire the requested memory allocation. |
| 4536 | |
| 4537 | Support for setting user limits on image width and height was enabled |
| 4538 | by default. The functions png_set_user_limits(), png_get_user_width_max(), |
| 4539 | and png_get_user_height_max() were added at libpng-1.2.6. |
| 4540 | |
| 4541 | The png_set_add_alpha() function was added at libpng-1.2.7. |
| 4542 | |
| 4543 | The function png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8() was added at libpng-1.2.9. |
| 4544 | Unlike png_set_gray_1_2_4_to_8(), the new function does not expand the |
| 4545 | tRNS chunk to alpha. The png_set_gray_1_2_4_to_8() function is |
| 4546 | deprecated. |
| 4547 | |
| 4548 | A number of macro definitions in support of runtime selection of |
| 4549 | assembler code features (especially Intel MMX code support) were |
| 4550 | added at libpng-1.2.0: |
| 4551 | |
| 4552 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_SUPPORT_COMPILED |
| 4553 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_SUPPORT_IN_CPU |
| 4554 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_COMBINE_ROW |
| 4555 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_INTERLACE |
| 4556 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_FILTER_SUB |
| 4557 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_FILTER_UP |
| 4558 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_FILTER_AVG |
| 4559 | PNG_ASM_FLAG_MMX_READ_FILTER_PAETH |
| 4560 | PNG_ASM_FLAGS_INITIALIZED |
| 4561 | PNG_MMX_READ_FLAGS |
| 4562 | PNG_MMX_FLAGS |
| 4563 | PNG_MMX_WRITE_FLAGS |
| 4564 | PNG_MMX_FLAGS |
| 4565 | |
| 4566 | We added the following functions in support of runtime |
| 4567 | selection of assembler code features: |
| 4568 | |
| 4569 | png_get_mmx_flagmask() |
| 4570 | png_set_mmx_thresholds() |
| 4571 | png_get_asm_flags() |
| 4572 | png_get_mmx_bitdepth_threshold() |
| 4573 | png_get_mmx_rowbytes_threshold() |
| 4574 | png_set_asm_flags() |
| 4575 | |
| 4576 | We replaced all of these functions with simple stubs in libpng-1.2.20, |
| 4577 | when the Intel assembler code was removed due to a licensing issue. |
| 4578 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3d893a0 | 2009-08-31 13:32:46 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4579 | These macros are deprecated: |
| 4580 | |
| 4581 | PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_NOT_SUPPORTED |
| 4582 | PNG_PROGRESSIVE_READ_NOT_SUPPORTED |
| 4583 | PNG_NO_SEQUENTIAL_READ_SUPPORTED |
| 4584 | PNG_WRITE_TRANSFORMS_NOT_SUPPORTED |
| 4585 | PNG_READ_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_NOT_SUPPORTED |
| 4586 | PNG_WRITE_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_NOT_SUPPORTED |
| 4587 | |
| 4588 | They have been replaced, respectively, by: |
| 4589 | |
| 4590 | PNG_NO_READ_TRANSFORMS |
| 4591 | PNG_NO_PROGRESSIVE_READ |
| 4592 | PNG_NO_SEQUENTIAL_READ |
| 4593 | PNG_NO_WRITE_TRANSFORMS |
| 4594 | PNG_NO_READ_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS |
| 4595 | PNG_NO_WRITE_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS |
| 4596 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4597 | PNG_MAX_UINT was replaced with PNG_UINT_31_MAX. It has been |
| 4598 | deprecated since libpng-1.0.16 and libpng-1.2.6. |
| 4599 | |
| 4600 | The function |
| 4601 | png_check_sig(sig, num) |
| 4602 | was replaced with |
| 4603 | !png_sig_cmp(sig, 0, num) |
| 4604 | It has been deprecated since libpng-0.90. |
| 4605 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4606 | The function |
| 4607 | png_set_gray_1_2_4_to_8() |
| 4608 | which also expands tRNS to alpha was replaced with |
| 4609 | png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8() |
| 4610 | which does not. It has been deprecated since libpng-1.0.18 and 1.2.9. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4611 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4612 | X. Changes to Libpng from version 1.0.x/1.2.x to 1.4.x |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d740c84 | 2009-11-04 19:01:54 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4613 | |
| 4614 | Private libpng prototypes and macro definitions were moved from |
| 4615 | png.h and pngconf.h into a new pngpriv.h header file. |
| 4616 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4617 | Functions png_set_benign_errors(), png_benign_error(), and |
| 4618 | png_chunk_benign_error() were added. |
| 4619 | |
| 4620 | Support for setting the maximum amount of memory that the application |
| 4621 | will allocate for reading chunks was added, as a security measure. |
| 4622 | The functions png_set_chunk_cache_max() and png_get_chunk_cache_max() |
| 4623 | were added to the library. |
| 4624 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4625 | We implemented support for I/O states by adding png_ptr member io_state |
| 4626 | and functions png_get_io_chunk_name() and png_get_io_state() in pngget.c |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4627 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4f25bf3 | 2009-10-29 23:34:44 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4628 | We added PNG_TRANSFORM_GRAY_TO_RGB to the available high-level |
| 4629 | input transforms. |
| 4630 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4f25bf3 | 2009-10-29 23:34:44 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4631 | Checking for and reporting of errors in the IHDR chunk is more thorough. |
| 4632 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4633 | Support for global arrays was removed, to improve thread safety. |
| 4634 | |
| 4635 | Some obsolete/deprecated macros and functions have been removed. |
| 4636 | |
| 4637 | Typecasted NULL definitions such as |
| 4638 | #define png_voidp_NULL (png_voidp)NULL |
| 4639 | were eliminated. If you used these in your application, just use |
| 4640 | NULL instead. |
| 4641 | |
| 4642 | The png_struct and info_struct members "trans" and "trans_values" were |
| 4643 | changed to "trans_alpha" and "trans_color", respectively. |
| 4644 | |
| 4645 | The obsolete, unused pnggccrd.c and pngvcrd.c files and related makefiles |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4646 | were removed. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4647 | |
| 4648 | The PNG_1_0_X and PNG_1_2_X macros were eliminated. |
| 4649 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4f25bf3 | 2009-10-29 23:34:44 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4650 | The PNG_LEGACY_SUPPORTED macro was eliminated. |
| 4651 | |
| 4652 | Many WIN32_WCE #ifdefs were removed. |
| 4653 | |
| 4654 | The functions png_read_init(info_ptr), png_write_init(info_ptr), |
| 4655 | png_info_init(info_ptr), png_read_destroy(), and png_write_destroy() |
| 4656 | have been removed. They have been deprecated since libpng-0.95. |
| 4657 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4658 | The png_permit_empty_plte() was removed. It has been deprecated |
| 4659 | since libpng-1.0.9. Use png_permit_mng_features() instead. |
| 4660 | |
| 4661 | We removed the obsolete stub functions png_get_mmx_flagmask(), |
| 4662 | png_set_mmx_thresholds(), png_get_asm_flags(), |
| 4663 | png_get_mmx_bitdepth_threshold(), png_get_mmx_rowbytes_threshold(), |
| 4664 | png_set_asm_flags(), and png_mmx_supported() |
| 4665 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4666 | We removed the obsolete png_check_sig(), png_memcpy_check(), and |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4667 | png_memset_check() functions. Instead use !png_sig_cmp(), memcpy(), |
| 4668 | and memset(), respectively. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4669 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4670 | The function png_set_gray_1_2_4_to_8() was removed. It has been |
| 4671 | deprecated since libpng-1.0.18 and 1.2.9, when it was replaced with |
| 4672 | png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8() because the former function also |
John Bowler | 63d059a | 2011-02-12 09:03:44 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4673 | expanded any tRNS chunk to an alpha channel. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4674 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5b40b01 | 2010-11-25 07:16:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4675 | Macros for png_get_uint_16, png_get_uint_32, and png_get_int_32 |
| 4676 | were added and are used by default instead of the corresponding |
| 4677 | functions. Unfortunately, |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36bb79 | 2011-02-12 09:49:07 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4678 | from libpng-1.4.0 until 1.4.4, the png_get_uint_16 macro (but not the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5b40b01 | 2010-11-25 07:16:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4679 | function) incorrectly returned a value of type png_uint_32. |
| 4680 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4681 | We changed the prototype for png_malloc() from |
| 4682 | png_malloc(png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 size) |
| 4683 | to |
| 4684 | png_malloc(png_structp png_ptr, png_alloc_size_t size) |
| 4685 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e3f3c4e | 2010-02-07 18:08:50 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4686 | This also applies to the prototype for the user replacement malloc_fn(). |
| 4687 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4688 | The png_calloc() function was added and is used in place of |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2be8b64 | 2010-07-29 19:09:18 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4689 | of "png_malloc(); memset();" except in the case in png_read_png() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4690 | where the array consists of pointers; in this case a "for" loop is used |
| 4691 | after the png_malloc() to set the pointers to NULL, to give robust. |
| 4692 | behavior in case the application runs out of memory part-way through |
| 4693 | the process. |
| 4694 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4695 | We changed the prototypes of png_get_compression_buffer_size() and |
| 4696 | png_set_compression_buffer_size() to work with png_size_t instead of |
| 4697 | png_uint_32. |
| 4698 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 45af819 | 2009-12-30 08:37:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4699 | Support for numbered error messages was removed by default, since we |
| 4700 | never got around to actually numbering the error messages. The function |
| 4701 | png_set_strip_error_numbers() was removed from the library by default. |
| 4702 | |
| 4703 | The png_zalloc() and png_zfree() functions are no longer exported. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4704 | The png_zalloc() function no longer zeroes out the memory that it |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4705 | allocates. Applications that called png_zalloc(png_ptr, number, size) |
| 4706 | can call png_calloc(png_ptr, number*size) instead, and can call |
| 4707 | png_free() instead of png_zfree(). |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4708 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4709 | Support for dithering was disabled by default in libpng-1.4.0, because |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9f1cd70 | 2011-04-16 19:40:23 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4710 | it has not been well tested and doesn't actually "dither". |
| 4711 | The code was not |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4712 | removed, however, and could be enabled by building libpng with |
| 4713 | PNG_READ_DITHER_SUPPORTED defined. In libpng-1.4.2, this support |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4714 | was re-enabled, but the function was renamed png_set_quantize() to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 3cd7cff | 2010-04-16 19:27:08 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4715 | reflect more accurately what it actually does. At the same time, |
| 4716 | the PNG_DITHER_[RED,GREEN_BLUE]_BITS macros were also renamed to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4717 | PNG_QUANTIZE_[RED,GREEN,BLUE]_BITS, and PNG_READ_DITHER_SUPPORTED |
| 4718 | was renamed to PNG_READ_QUANTIZE_SUPPORTED. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6098807 | 2010-04-13 22:11:06 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4719 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4720 | We removed the trailing '.' from the warning and error messages. |
| 4721 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4722 | XI. Changes to Libpng from version 1.4.x to 1.5.x |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5b40b01 | 2010-11-25 07:16:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4723 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c36bb79 | 2011-02-12 09:49:07 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4724 | From libpng-1.4.0 until 1.4.4, the png_get_uint_16 macro (but not the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5b40b01 | 2010-11-25 07:16:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4725 | function) incorrectly returned a value of type png_uint_32. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4726 | The incorrect macro was removed from libpng-1.4.5. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5b40b01 | 2010-11-25 07:16:29 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4727 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4728 | Checking for invalid palette index on write was added at libpng |
| 4729 | 1.5.10. If a pixel contains an invalid (out-of-range) index libpng issues |
| 4730 | a benign error. This is enabled by default because this condition is an |
| 4731 | error according to the PNG specification, Clause 11.3.2, but the error can |
| 4732 | be ignored in each png_ptr with |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4733 | |
| 4734 | png_set_check_for_invalid_index(png_ptr, allowed); |
| 4735 | |
| 4736 | allowed - one of |
| 4737 | 0: disable benign error (accept the |
| 4738 | invalid data without warning). |
| 4739 | 1: enable benign error (treat the |
| 4740 | invalid data as an error or a |
| 4741 | warning). |
| 4742 | |
| 4743 | If the error is ignored, or if png_benign_error() treats it as a warning, |
| 4744 | any invalid pixels are decoded as opaque black by the decoder and written |
| 4745 | as-is by the encoder. |
| 4746 | |
| 4747 | Retrieving the maximum palette index found was added at libpng-1.5.15. |
| 4748 | This statement must appear after png_read_png() or png_read_image() while |
| 4749 | reading, and after png_write_png() or png_write_image() while writing. |
| 4750 | |
| 4751 | int max_palette = png_get_palette_max(png_ptr, info_ptr); |
| 4752 | |
| 4753 | This will return the maximum palette index found in the image, or "-1" if |
| 4754 | the palette was not checked, or "0" if no palette was found. Note that this |
| 4755 | does not account for any palette index used by ancillary chunks such as the |
| 4756 | bKGD chunk; you must check those separately to determine the maximum |
| 4757 | palette index actually used. |
| 4758 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4759 | There are no substantial API changes between the non-deprecated parts of |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4760 | the 1.4.5 API and the 1.5.0 API; however, the ability to directly access |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4761 | members of the main libpng control structures, png_struct and png_info, |
| 4762 | deprecated in earlier versions of libpng, has been completely removed from |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4763 | libpng 1.5. |
| 4764 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4765 | We no longer include zlib.h in png.h. The include statement has been moved |
| 4766 | to pngstruct.h, where it is not accessible by applications. Applications that |
| 4767 | need access to information in zlib.h will need to add the '#include "zlib.h"' |
| 4768 | directive. It does not matter whether this is placed prior to or after |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 00879b1 | 2011-01-15 19:25:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4769 | the '"#include png.h"' directive. |
| 4770 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4771 | The png_sprintf(), png_strcpy(), and png_strncpy() macros are no longer used |
| 4772 | and were removed. |
| 4773 | |
| 4774 | We moved the png_strlen(), png_memcpy(), png_memset(), and png_memcmp() |
| 4775 | macros into a private header file (pngpriv.h) that is not accessible to |
| 4776 | applications. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 00879b1 | 2011-01-15 19:25:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4777 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9d23b40 | 2011-01-08 10:42:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4778 | In png_get_iCCP, the type of "profile" was changed from png_charpp |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4779 | to png_bytepp, and in png_set_iCCP, from png_charp to png_const_bytep. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 9d23b40 | 2011-01-08 10:42:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4780 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4781 | There are changes of form in png.h, including new and changed macros to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4782 | declare parts of the API. Some API functions with arguments that are |
| 4783 | pointers to data not modified within the function have been corrected to |
| 4784 | declare these arguments with PNG_CONST. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4785 | |
| 4786 | Much of the internal use of C macros to control the library build has also |
| 4787 | changed and some of this is visible in the exported header files, in |
| 4788 | particular the use of macros to control data and API elements visible |
| 4789 | during application compilation may require significant revision to |
| 4790 | application code. (It is extremely rare for an application to do this.) |
| 4791 | |
| 4792 | Any program that compiled against libpng 1.4 and did not use deprecated |
| 4793 | features or access internal library structures should compile and work |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d08b6bd | 2011-02-19 15:50:17 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4794 | against libpng 1.5, except for the change in the prototype for |
| 4795 | png_get_iCCP() and png_set_iCCP() API functions mentioned above. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4796 | |
John Bowler | 660c6e4 | 2010-12-19 06:22:23 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4797 | libpng 1.5.0 adds PNG_ PASS macros to help in the reading and writing of |
| 4798 | interlaced images. The macros return the number of rows and columns in |
| 4799 | each pass and information that can be used to de-interlace and (if |
| 4800 | absolutely necessary) interlace an image. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4801 | |
| 4802 | libpng 1.5.0 adds an API png_longjmp(png_ptr, value). This API calls |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d08b6bd | 2011-02-19 15:50:17 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4803 | the application-provided png_longjmp_ptr on the internal, but application |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 33ced44 | 2011-04-27 14:58:06 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4804 | initialized, longjmp buffer. It is provided as a convenience to avoid |
| 4805 | the need to use the png_jmpbuf macro, which had the unnecessary side |
| 4806 | effect of resetting the internal png_longjmp_ptr value. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4807 | |
| 4808 | libpng 1.5.0 includes a complete fixed point API. By default this is |
| 4809 | present along with the corresponding floating point API. In general the |
| 4810 | fixed point API is faster and smaller than the floating point one because |
| 4811 | the PNG file format used fixed point, not floating point. This applies |
| 4812 | even if the library uses floating point in internal calculations. A new |
| 4813 | macro, PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED, reveals whether the library |
| 4814 | uses floating point arithmetic (the default) or fixed point arithmetic |
| 4815 | internally for performance critical calculations such as gamma correction. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 00879b1 | 2011-01-15 19:25:34 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4816 | In some cases, the gamma calculations may produce slightly different |
| 4817 | results. This has changed the results in png_rgb_to_gray and in alpha |
| 4818 | composition (png_set_background for example). This applies even if the |
| 4819 | original image was already linear (gamma == 1.0) and, therefore, it is |
| 4820 | not necessary to linearize the image. This is because libpng has *not* |
| 4821 | been changed to optimize that case correctly, yet. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4822 | |
| 4823 | Fixed point support for the sCAL chunk comes with an important caveat; |
| 4824 | the sCAL specification uses a decimal encoding of floating point values |
| 4825 | and the accuracy of PNG fixed point values is insufficient for |
| 4826 | representation of these values. Consequently a "string" API |
| 4827 | (png_get_sCAL_s and png_set_sCAL_s) is the only reliable way of reading |
| 4828 | arbitrary sCAL chunks in the absence of either the floating point API or |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4829 | internal floating point calculations. Starting with libpng-1.5.0, both |
| 4830 | of these functions are present when PNG_sCAL_SUPPORTED is defined. Prior |
| 4831 | to libpng-1.5.0, their presence also depended upon PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED |
| 4832 | being defined and PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED not being defined. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4833 | |
| 4834 | Applications no longer need to include the optional distribution header |
| 4835 | file pngusr.h or define the corresponding macros during application |
| 4836 | build in order to see the correct variant of the libpng API. From 1.5.0 |
| 4837 | application code can check for the corresponding _SUPPORTED macro: |
| 4838 | |
| 4839 | #ifdef PNG_INCH_CONVERSIONS_SUPPORTED |
| 4840 | /* code that uses the inch conversion APIs. */ |
| 4841 | #endif |
| 4842 | |
| 4843 | This macro will only be defined if the inch conversion functions have been |
| 4844 | compiled into libpng. The full set of macros, and whether or not support |
| 4845 | has been compiled in, are available in the header file pnglibconf.h. |
| 4846 | This header file is specific to the libpng build. Notice that prior to |
| 4847 | 1.5.0 the _SUPPORTED macros would always have the default definition unless |
| 4848 | reset by pngusr.h or by explicit settings on the compiler command line. |
| 4849 | These settings may produce compiler warnings or errors in 1.5.0 because |
| 4850 | of macro redefinition. |
| 4851 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4852 | Applications can now choose whether to use these macros or to call the |
| 4853 | corresponding function by defining PNG_USE_READ_MACROS or |
| 4854 | PNG_NO_USE_READ_MACROS before including png.h. Notice that this is |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4855 | only supported from 1.5.0; defining PNG_NO_USE_READ_MACROS prior to 1.5.0 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 95ba417 | 2011-09-08 12:21:42 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4856 | will lead to a link failure. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 59fa3e9 | 2011-01-06 07:07:06 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4857 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4858 | Prior to libpng-1.5.4, the zlib compressor used the same set of parameters |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8eb8833 | 2011-04-01 00:16:50 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4859 | when compressing the IDAT data and textual data such as zTXt and iCCP. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4860 | In libpng-1.5.4 we reinitialized the zlib stream for each type of data. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8eb8833 | 2011-04-01 00:16:50 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4861 | We added five png_set_text_*() functions for setting the parameters to |
| 4862 | use with textual data. |
| 4863 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4864 | Prior to libpng-1.5.4, the PNG_READ_16_TO_8_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED |
John Bowler | b2bee33 | 2011-06-10 23:24:58 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4865 | option was off by default, and slightly inaccurate scaling occurred. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | fb29e51 | 2011-06-17 20:38:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4866 | This option can no longer be turned off, and the choice of accurate |
| 4867 | or inaccurate 16-to-8 scaling is by using the new png_set_scale_16_to_8() |
| 4868 | API for accurate scaling or the old png_set_strip_16_to_8() API for simple |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4869 | chopping. In libpng-1.5.4, the PNG_READ_16_TO_8_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED |
| 4870 | macro became PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED, and the PNG_READ_16_TO_8 |
| 4871 | macro became PNG_READ_STRIP_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED, to enable the two |
| 4872 | png_set_*_16_to_8() functions separately. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0cb906d | 2011-06-11 14:22:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4873 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 733b131 | 2011-06-15 13:21:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4874 | Prior to libpng-1.5.4, the png_set_user_limits() function could only be |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0cb906d | 2011-06-11 14:22:22 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4875 | used to reduce the width and height limits from the value of |
| 4876 | PNG_USER_WIDTH_MAX and PNG_USER_HEIGHT_MAX, although this document said |
| 4877 | that it could be used to override them. Now this function will reduce or |
| 4878 | increase the limits. |
John Bowler | b2bee33 | 2011-06-10 23:24:58 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4879 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4880 | Starting in libpng-1.5.10, the user limits can be set en masse with the |
| 4881 | configuration option PNG_SAFE_LIMITS_SUPPORTED. If this option is enabled, |
| 4882 | a set of "safe" limits is applied in pngpriv.h. These can be overridden by |
| 4883 | application calls to png_set_user_limits(), png_set_user_chunk_cache_max(), |
| 4884 | and/or png_set_user_malloc_max() that increase or decrease the limits. Also, |
| 4885 | in libpng-1.5.10 the default width and height limits were increased |
| 4886 | from 1,000,000 to 0x7ffffff (i.e., made unlimited). Therefore, the |
| 4887 | limits are now |
| 4888 | default safe |
| 4889 | png_user_width_max 0x7fffffff 1,000,000 |
| 4890 | png_user_height_max 0x7fffffff 1,000,000 |
| 4891 | png_user_chunk_cache_max 0 (unlimited) 128 |
| 4892 | png_user_chunk_malloc_max 0 (unlimited) 8,000,000 |
| 4893 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4894 | The png_set_option() function (and the "options" member of the png struct) was |
| 4895 | added to libpng-1.5.15. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c2a15d0 | 2014-03-16 19:53:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4896 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 2ca2a0b | 2014-03-16 21:47:52 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4897 | The library now supports a complete fixed point implementation and can |
| 4898 | thus be used on systems that have no floating point support or very |
| 4899 | limited or slow support. Previously gamma correction, an essential part |
| 4900 | of complete PNG support, required reasonably fast floating point. |
| 4901 | |
| 4902 | As part of this the choice of internal implementation has been made |
| 4903 | independent of the choice of fixed versus floating point APIs and all the |
| 4904 | missing fixed point APIs have been implemented. |
| 4905 | |
| 4906 | The exact mechanism used to control attributes of API functions has |
| 4907 | changed, as described in the INSTALL file. |
| 4908 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c2a15d0 | 2014-03-16 19:53:29 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4909 | A new test program, pngvalid, is provided in addition to pngtest. |
| 4910 | pngvalid validates the arithmetic accuracy of the gamma correction |
| 4911 | calculations and includes a number of validations of the file format. |
| 4912 | A subset of the full range of tests is run when "make check" is done |
| 4913 | (in the 'configure' build.) pngvalid also allows total allocated memory |
| 4914 | usage to be evaluated and performs additional memory overwrite validation. |
| 4915 | |
| 4916 | Many changes to individual feature macros have been made. The following |
| 4917 | are the changes most likely to be noticed by library builders who |
| 4918 | configure libpng: |
| 4919 | |
| 4920 | 1) All feature macros now have consistent naming: |
| 4921 | |
| 4922 | #define PNG_NO_feature turns the feature off |
| 4923 | #define PNG_feature_SUPPORTED turns the feature on |
| 4924 | |
| 4925 | pnglibconf.h contains one line for each feature macro which is either: |
| 4926 | |
| 4927 | #define PNG_feature_SUPPORTED |
| 4928 | |
| 4929 | if the feature is supported or: |
| 4930 | |
| 4931 | /*#undef PNG_feature_SUPPORTED*/ |
| 4932 | |
| 4933 | if it is not. Library code consistently checks for the 'SUPPORTED' macro. |
| 4934 | It does not, and libpng applications should not, check for the 'NO' macro |
| 4935 | which will not normally be defined even if the feature is not supported. |
| 4936 | The 'NO' macros are only used internally for setting or not setting the |
| 4937 | corresponding 'SUPPORTED' macros. |
| 4938 | |
| 4939 | Compatibility with the old names is provided as follows: |
| 4940 | |
| 4941 | PNG_INCH_CONVERSIONS turns on PNG_INCH_CONVERSIONS_SUPPORTED |
| 4942 | |
| 4943 | And the following definitions disable the corresponding feature: |
| 4944 | |
| 4945 | PNG_SETJMP_NOT_SUPPORTED disables SETJMP |
| 4946 | PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_NOT_SUPPORTED disables READ_TRANSFORMS |
| 4947 | PNG_NO_READ_COMPOSITED_NODIV disables READ_COMPOSITE_NODIV |
| 4948 | PNG_WRITE_TRANSFORMS_NOT_SUPPORTED disables WRITE_TRANSFORMS |
| 4949 | PNG_READ_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_NOT_SUPPORTED disables READ_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS |
| 4950 | PNG_WRITE_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_NOT_SUPPORTED disables WRITE_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS |
| 4951 | |
| 4952 | Library builders should remove use of the above, inconsistent, names. |
| 4953 | |
| 4954 | 2) Warning and error message formatting was previously conditional on |
| 4955 | the STDIO feature. The library has been changed to use the |
| 4956 | CONSOLE_IO feature instead. This means that if CONSOLE_IO is disabled |
| 4957 | the library no longer uses the printf(3) functions, even though the |
| 4958 | default read/write implementations use (FILE) style stdio.h functions. |
| 4959 | |
| 4960 | 3) Three feature macros now control the fixed/floating point decisions: |
| 4961 | |
| 4962 | PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED enables the floating point APIs |
| 4963 | |
| 4964 | PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED enables the fixed point APIs; however, in |
| 4965 | practice these are normally required internally anyway (because the PNG |
| 4966 | file format is fixed point), therefore in most cases PNG_NO_FIXED_POINT |
| 4967 | merely stops the function from being exported. |
| 4968 | |
| 4969 | PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED chooses between the internal floating |
| 4970 | point implementation or the fixed point one. Typically the fixed point |
| 4971 | implementation is larger and slower than the floating point implementation |
| 4972 | on a system that supports floating point; however, it may be faster on a |
| 4973 | system which lacks floating point hardware and therefore uses a software |
| 4974 | emulation. |
| 4975 | |
| 4976 | 4) Added PNG_{READ,WRITE}_INT_FUNCTIONS_SUPPORTED. This allows the |
| 4977 | functions to read and write ints to be disabled independently of |
| 4978 | PNG_USE_READ_MACROS, which allows libpng to be built with the functions |
| 4979 | even though the default is to use the macros - this allows applications |
| 4980 | to choose at app buildtime whether or not to use macros (previously |
| 4981 | impossible because the functions weren't in the default build.) |
| 4982 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4983 | XII. Changes to Libpng from version 1.5.x to 1.6.x |
| 4984 | |
| 4985 | A "simplified API" has been added (see documentation in png.h and a simple |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 4986 | example in contrib/examples/pngtopng.c). The new publicly visible API |
| 4987 | includes the following: |
| 4988 | |
| 4989 | macros: |
| 4990 | PNG_FORMAT_* |
| 4991 | PNG_IMAGE_* |
| 4992 | structures: |
| 4993 | png_control |
| 4994 | png_image |
| 4995 | read functions |
| 4996 | png_image_begin_read_from_file() |
| 4997 | png_image_begin_read_from_stdio() |
| 4998 | png_image_begin_read_from_memory() |
| 4999 | png_image_finish_read() |
| 5000 | png_image_free() |
| 5001 | write functions |
| 5002 | png_image_write_to_file() |
| 5003 | png_image_write_to_stdio() |
| 5004 | |
| 5005 | Starting with libpng-1.6.0, you can configure libpng to prefix all exported |
| 5006 | symbols, using the PNG_PREFIX macro. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5bffd6c | 2012-01-31 22:21:32 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5007 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5008 | We no longer include string.h in png.h. The include statement has been moved |
| 5009 | to pngpriv.h, where it is not accessible by applications. Applications that |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5010 | need access to information in string.h must add an '#include <string.h>' |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5011 | directive. It does not matter whether this is placed prior to or after |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5012 | the '#include "png.h"' directive. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5013 | |
| 5014 | The following API are now DEPRECATED: |
| 5015 | png_info_init_3() |
| 5016 | png_convert_to_rfc1123() which has been replaced |
| 5017 | with png_convert_to_rfc1123_buffer() |
| 5018 | png_malloc_default() |
| 5019 | png_free_default() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5020 | png_reset_zstream() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5021 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5022 | The following have been removed: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 5a956a7 | 2011-12-22 14:23:37 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5023 | png_get_io_chunk_name(), which has been replaced |
| 5024 | with png_get_io_chunk_type(). The new |
| 5025 | function returns a 32-bit integer instead of |
| 5026 | a string. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5027 | The png_sizeof(), png_strlen(), png_memcpy(), png_memcmp(), and |
| 5028 | png_memset() macros are no longer used in the libpng sources and |
| 5029 | have been removed. These had already been made invisible to applications |
| 5030 | (i.e., defined in the private pngpriv.h header file) since libpng-1.5.0. |
| 5031 | |
| 5032 | The signatures of many exported functions were changed, such that |
| 5033 | png_structp became png_structrp or png_const_structrp |
| 5034 | png_infop became png_inforp or png_const_inforp |
| 5035 | where "rp" indicates a "restricted pointer". |
| 5036 | |
| 5037 | Error detection in some chunks has improved; in particular the iCCP chunk |
| 5038 | reader now does pretty complete validation of the basic format. Some bad |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5039 | profiles that were previously accepted are now accepted with a warning or |
| 5040 | rejected, depending upon the png_set_benign_errors() setting, in particular the |
| 5041 | very old broken Microsoft/HP 3144-byte sRGB profile. The PNG spec requirement |
| 5042 | that only grayscale profiles may appear in images with color type 0 or 4 and |
| 5043 | that even if the image only contains gray pixels, only RGB profiles may appear |
| 5044 | in images with color type 2, 3, or 6, is now enforced. The sRGB chunk |
| 5045 | is allowed to appear in images with any color type. |
| 5046 | |
| 5047 | Prior to libpng-1.6.0 a warning would be issued if the iTXt chunk contained |
| 5048 | an empty language field or an empty translated keyword. Both of these |
| 5049 | are allowed by the PNG specification, so these warnings are no longer issued. |
| 5050 | |
| 5051 | The library now issues an error if the application attempts to set a |
| 5052 | transform after it calls png_read_update_info() or if it attempts to call |
| 5053 | both png_read_update_info() and png_start_read_image() or to call either |
| 5054 | of them more than once. |
| 5055 | |
| 5056 | The default condition for benign_errors is now to treat benign errors as |
| 5057 | warnings while reading and as errors while writing. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d5dd93f | 2013-07-02 09:20:36 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5058 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5059 | The library now issues a warning if both background processing and RGB to |
| 5060 | gray are used when gamma correction happens. As with previous versions of |
| 5061 | the library the results are numerically very incorrect in this case. |
| 5062 | |
| 5063 | There are some minor arithmetic changes in some transforms such as |
| 5064 | png_set_background(), that might be detected by certain regression tests. |
| 5065 | |
| 5066 | Unknown chunk handling has been improved internally, without any API change. |
| 5067 | This adds more correct option control of the unknown handling, corrects |
| 5068 | a pre-existing bug where the per-chunk 'keep' setting is ignored, and makes |
| 5069 | it possible to skip IDAT chunks in the sequential reader. |
| 5070 | |
| 5071 | The machine-generated configure files are no longer included in branches |
| 5072 | libpng16 and later of the GIT repository. They continue to be included |
| 5073 | in the tarball releases, however. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8064777 | 2013-02-04 19:50:56 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5074 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5075 | Libpng-1.6.0 through 1.6.2 used the CMF bytes at the beginning of the IDAT |
| 5076 | stream to set the size of the sliding window for reading instead of using the |
| 5077 | default 32-kbyte sliding window size. It was discovered that there are |
| 5078 | hundreds of PNG files in the wild that have incorrect CMF bytes that caused |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 72855fb | 2014-04-13 21:27:25 -0500 | [diff] [blame^] | 5079 | zlib to issue the "invalid distance too far back" error and reject the file. |
| 5080 | Libpng-1.6.3 and later calculate their own safe CMF from the image dimensions, |
| 5081 | provide a way to revert to the libpng-1.5.x behavior (ignoring the CMF bytes |
| 5082 | and using a 32-kbyte sliding window), by using |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5083 | |
| 5084 | png_set_option(png_ptr, PNG_MAXIMUM_INFLATE_WINDOW, |
| 5085 | PNG_OPTION_ON); |
| 5086 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 72855fb | 2014-04-13 21:27:25 -0500 | [diff] [blame^] | 5087 | and provide a tool (contrib/tools/pngfix) for rewriting a PNG file while |
| 5088 | optimizing the CMF bytes in its IDAT chunk correctly. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5089 | |
| 5090 | Libpng-1.6.0 and libpng-1.6.1 wrote uncompressed iTXt chunks with the wrong |
| 5091 | length, which resulted in PNG files that cannot be read beyond the bad iTXt |
| 5092 | chunk. This error was fixed in libpng-1.6.3, and a tool (called |
| 5093 | contrib/tools/png-fix-itxt) has been added to the libpng distribution. |
| 5094 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5095 | XIII. Detecting libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 37e7e0b | 2009-06-02 13:46:41 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5096 | |
| 5097 | The png_get_io_ptr() function has been present since libpng-0.88, has never |
| 5098 | changed, and is unaffected by conditional compilation macros. It is the |
| 5099 | best choice for use in configure scripts for detecting the presence of any |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 99708d5 | 2009-06-29 17:30:00 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5100 | libpng version since 0.88. In an autoconf "configure.in" you could use |
| 5101 | |
| 5102 | AC_CHECK_LIB(png, png_get_io_ptr, ... |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 37e7e0b | 2009-06-02 13:46:41 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5103 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5104 | XV. Source code repository |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5105 | |
| 5106 | Since about February 2009, version 1.2.34, libpng has been under "git" source |
| 5107 | control. The git repository was built from old libpng-x.y.z.tar.gz files |
| 5108 | going back to version 0.70. You can access the git repository (read only) |
| 5109 | at |
| 5110 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5111 | git://git.code.sf.net/p/libpng/code |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5112 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5113 | or you can browse it with a web browser by selecting the "code" button at |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5114 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5115 | https://sourceforge.net/projects/libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5116 | |
| 5117 | Patches can be sent to glennrp at users.sourceforge.net or to |
| 5118 | png-mng-implement at lists.sourceforge.net or you can upload them to |
| 5119 | the libpng bug tracker at |
| 5120 | |
| 5121 | http://libpng.sourceforge.net |
| 5122 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5123 | We also accept patches built from the tar or zip distributions, and |
| 5124 | simple verbal discriptions of bug fixes, reported either to the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | a5e5547 | 2011-07-12 10:13:32 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5125 | SourceForge bug tracker, to the png-mng-implement at lists.sf.net |
| 5126 | mailing list, or directly to glennrp. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7bc2501 | 2011-01-21 23:29:09 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5127 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5128 | XV. Coding style |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5129 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | c4b3718 | 2014-04-06 08:59:57 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5130 | Our coding style is similar to the "Allman" style |
| 5131 | (See http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Indent_style#Allman_style), with curly |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5132 | braces on separate lines: |
| 5133 | |
| 5134 | if (condition) |
| 5135 | { |
| 5136 | action; |
| 5137 | } |
| 5138 | |
| 5139 | else if (another condition) |
| 5140 | { |
| 5141 | another action; |
| 5142 | } |
| 5143 | |
| 5144 | The braces can be omitted from simple one-line actions: |
| 5145 | |
| 5146 | if (condition) |
| 5147 | return (0); |
| 5148 | |
| 5149 | We use 3-space indentation, except for continued statements which |
| 5150 | are usually indented the same as the first line of the statement |
| 5151 | plus four more spaces. |
| 5152 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 6076da8 | 2009-09-30 12:28:07 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5153 | For macro definitions we use 2-space indentation, always leaving the "#" |
| 5154 | in the first column. |
| 5155 | |
| 5156 | #ifndef PNG_NO_FEATURE |
| 5157 | # ifndef PNG_FEATURE_SUPPORTED |
| 5158 | # define PNG_FEATURE_SUPPORTED |
| 5159 | # endif |
| 5160 | #endif |
| 5161 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5162 | Comments appear with the leading "/*" at the same indentation as |
| 5163 | the statement that follows the comment: |
| 5164 | |
| 5165 | /* Single-line comment */ |
| 5166 | statement; |
| 5167 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e4c706a | 2010-03-06 14:51:54 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5168 | /* This is a multiple-line |
| 5169 | * comment. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5170 | */ |
| 5171 | statement; |
| 5172 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e4c706a | 2010-03-06 14:51:54 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5173 | Very short comments can be placed after the end of the statement |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5174 | to which they pertain: |
| 5175 | |
| 5176 | statement; /* comment */ |
| 5177 | |
| 5178 | We don't use C++ style ("//") comments. We have, however, |
| 5179 | used them in the past in some now-abandoned MMX assembler |
| 5180 | code. |
| 5181 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4df37bf | 2014-03-06 12:35:04 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5182 | Functions and their curly braces are not indented, and |
| 5183 | exported functions are marked with PNGAPI: |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5184 | |
| 5185 | /* This is a public function that is visible to |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5186 | * application programmers. It does thus-and-so. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5187 | */ |
| 5188 | void PNGAPI |
| 5189 | png_exported_function(png_ptr, png_info, foo) |
| 5190 | { |
| 5191 | body; |
| 5192 | } |
| 5193 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5194 | The return type and decorations are placed on a separate line |
| 5195 | ahead of the function name, as illustrated above. |
| 5196 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 416976f | 2009-07-27 22:16:09 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5197 | The prototypes for all exported functions appear in png.h, |
| 5198 | above the comment that says |
| 5199 | |
| 5200 | /* Maintainer: Put new public prototypes here ... */ |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5201 | |
| 5202 | We mark all non-exported functions with "/* PRIVATE */"": |
| 5203 | |
| 5204 | void /* PRIVATE */ |
| 5205 | png_non_exported_function(png_ptr, png_info, foo) |
| 5206 | { |
| 5207 | body; |
| 5208 | } |
| 5209 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 416976f | 2009-07-27 22:16:09 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5210 | The prototypes for non-exported functions (except for those in |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4f25bf3 | 2009-10-29 23:34:44 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5211 | pngtest) appear in |
| 5212 | pngpriv.h |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 416976f | 2009-07-27 22:16:09 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5213 | above the comment that says |
| 5214 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5215 | /* Maintainer: Put new private prototypes here ^ */ |
| 5216 | |
| 5217 | We put a space after the "sizeof" operator and we omit the |
| 5218 | optional parentheses around its argument when the argument |
| 5219 | is an expression, not a type name, and we always enclose the |
| 5220 | sizeof operator, with its argument, in parentheses: |
| 5221 | |
| 5222 | (sizeof (png_uint_32)) |
| 5223 | (sizeof array) |
| 5224 | |
| 5225 | Prior to libpng-1.6.0 we used a "png_sizeof()" macro, formatted as |
| 5226 | though it were a function. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | ece07cf | 2012-08-10 18:08:02 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5227 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cbbe9a5 | 2011-01-29 16:12:11 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5228 | To avoid polluting the global namespace, the names of all exported |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5229 | functions and variables begin with "png_", and all publicly visible C |
| 5230 | preprocessor macros begin with "PNG". We request that applications that |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | cbbe9a5 | 2011-01-29 16:12:11 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5231 | use libpng *not* begin any of their own symbols with either of these strings. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5232 | |
| 5233 | We put a space after each comma and after each semicolon |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 49a56e7 | 2010-12-06 20:06:01 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5234 | in "for" statements, and we put spaces before and after each |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | e4c706a | 2010-03-06 14:51:54 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5235 | C binary operator and after "for" or "while", and before |
| 5236 | "?". We don't put a space between a typecast and the expression |
| 5237 | being cast, nor do we put one between a function name and the |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5238 | left parenthesis that follows it: |
| 5239 | |
| 5240 | for (i = 2; i > 0; --i) |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4e6b5e9 | 2009-09-23 10:24:53 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5241 | y[i] = a(x) + (int)b; |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5242 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5243 | We prefer #ifdef and #ifndef to #if defined() and #if !defined() |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5244 | when there is only one macro being tested. We always use parentheses |
| 5245 | with "defined". |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | d60c886 | 2009-06-15 21:56:14 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5246 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 8db1998 | 2011-10-27 16:17:24 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5247 | We prefer to express integers that are used as bit masks in hex format, |
| 5248 | with an even number of lower-case hex digits (e.g., 0x00, 0xff, 0x0100). |
| 5249 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5250 | We prefer to use underscores in variable names rather than camelCase, except |
| 5251 | for a few type names that we inherit from zlib.h. |
| 5252 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7017c40 | 2014-03-16 20:29:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5253 | We prefer "if (something != 0)" and "if (something == 0)" |
| 5254 | over "if (something)" and if "(!something)", respectively. |
| 5255 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 4e6b5e9 | 2009-09-23 10:24:53 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5256 | We do not use the TAB character for indentation in the C sources. |
| 5257 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 62ca98e | 2009-12-20 15:14:57 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5258 | Lines do not exceed 80 characters. |
| 5259 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | f210a05 | 2009-11-12 10:02:24 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5260 | Other rules can be inferred by inspecting the libpng source. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | b1c0d33 | 2009-05-15 20:39:34 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5261 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 0501c1c | 2012-01-11 14:00:52 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5262 | XVI. Y2K Compliance in libpng |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5263 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 72855fb | 2014-04-13 21:27:25 -0500 | [diff] [blame^] | 5264 | April 13, 2014 |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5265 | |
| 5266 | Since the PNG Development group is an ad-hoc body, we can't make |
| 5267 | an official declaration. |
| 5268 | |
| 5269 | This is your unofficial assurance that libpng from version 0.71 and |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 7a0ca96 | 2014-04-06 12:53:47 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5270 | upward through 1.6.11beta04 are Y2K compliant. It is my belief that earlier |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5271 | versions were also Y2K compliant. |
| 5272 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5273 | Libpng only has two year fields. One is a 2-byte unsigned integer |
| 5274 | that will hold years up to 65535. The other, which is deprecated, |
| 5275 | holds the date in text format, and will hold years up to 9999. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5276 | |
| 5277 | The integer is |
| 5278 | "png_uint_16 year" in png_time_struct. |
| 5279 | |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson | 871b1d0 | 2013-03-02 14:58:22 -0600 | [diff] [blame] | 5280 | The string is |
| 5281 | "char time_buffer[29]" in png_struct. This is no longer used |
| 5282 | in libpng-1.6.x and will be removed from libpng-1.7.0. |
Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp@comcast.net | 9a692c0 | 2009-05-15 20:38:11 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 5283 | |
| 5284 | There are seven time-related functions: |
| 5285 | |
| 5286 | png_convert_to_rfc_1123() in png.c |
| 5287 | (formerly png_convert_to_rfc_1152() in error) |
| 5288 | png_convert_from_struct_tm() in pngwrite.c, called |
| 5289 | in pngwrite.c |
| 5290 | png_convert_from_time_t() in pngwrite.c |
| 5291 | png_get_tIME() in pngget.c |
| 5292 | png_handle_tIME() in pngrutil.c, called in pngread.c |
| 5293 | png_set_tIME() in pngset.c |
| 5294 | png_write_tIME() in pngwutil.c, called in pngwrite.c |
| 5295 | |
| 5296 | All appear to handle dates properly in a Y2K environment. The |
| 5297 | png_convert_from_time_t() function calls gmtime() to convert from system |
| 5298 | clock time, which returns (year - 1900), which we properly convert to |
| 5299 | the full 4-digit year. There is a possibility that applications using |
| 5300 | libpng are not passing 4-digit years into the png_convert_to_rfc_1123() |
| 5301 | function, or that they are incorrectly passing only a 2-digit year |
| 5302 | instead of "year - 1900" into the png_convert_from_struct_tm() function, |
| 5303 | but this is not under our control. The libpng documentation has always |
| 5304 | stated that it works with 4-digit years, and the APIs have been |
| 5305 | documented as such. |
| 5306 | |
| 5307 | The tIME chunk itself is also Y2K compliant. It uses a 2-byte unsigned |
| 5308 | integer to hold the year, and can hold years as large as 65535. |
| 5309 | |
| 5310 | zlib, upon which libpng depends, is also Y2K compliant. It contains |
| 5311 | no date-related code. |
| 5312 | |
| 5313 | |
| 5314 | Glenn Randers-Pehrson |
| 5315 | libpng maintainer |
| 5316 | PNG Development Group |